MC9S08QD4 MC9S08QD2 S9S08QD4 S9S08QD2 Data Sheet HCS08 Microcontrollers MC9S08QD4 Rev. 3 11/2007 freescale.com MC9S08QD4 Series Features 8-Bit HCS08 Central Processor Unit (CPU) • • • • • 16 MHz HCS08 CPU (central processor unit) HC08 instruction set with added BGND instruction Background debugging system Breakpoint capability to allow single breakpoint setting during in-circuit debugging (plus two more breakpoints in on-chip debug module) Support for up to 32 interrupt/reset sources • Peripherals • • Memory • • • Flash read/program/erase over full operating voltage and temperature Flash size: — MC9S08QD4/S9S08QD4: 4096 bytes — MC9S08QD2/S9S08QD2: 2048 bytes RAM size — MC9S08QD4/S9S08QD4: 256 bytes — MC9S08QD2/S9S08QD2: 128 bytes Power-Saving Modes • • • • Wait plus three stops ICS — Internal clock source module (ICS) containing a frequency-locked-loop (FLL) controlled by internal. Precision trimming of internal reference allows 0.2% resolution and 2% deviation over temperature and voltage. System Protection • • • • Watchdog computer operating properly (COP) reset with option to run from dedicated 32 kHz internal clock source or bus clock Low-voltage detection with reset or interrupt Illegal opcode detection with reset Illegal address detection with reset ADC — 4-channel, 10-bit analog-to-digital converter with automatic compare function, asynchronous clock source, temperature sensor and internal bandgap reference channel. ADC is hardware triggerable using the RTI counter. TIM1 — 2-channel timer/pulse-width modulator; each channel can be used for input capture, output compare, buffered edge-aligned PWM, or buffered center-aligned PWM TIM2 — 1-channel timer/pulse-width modulator; each channel can be used for input capture, output compare, buffered edge-aligned PWM, or buffered center-aligned PWM KBI — 4-pin keyboard interrupt module with software selectable polarity on edge or edge/level modes Input/Output Clock Source Options • Flash block protect • • • Four General-purpose input/output (I/O) pins, one input-only pin and one output-only pin. Outputs 10 mA each, 60 mA maximum for package. Software selectable pullups on ports when used as input Software selectable slew rate control and drive strength on ports when used as output Internal pullup on RESET and IRQ pin to reduce customer system cost Development Support • Single-wire background debug interface Package Options • • • 8-pin SOIC package 8-pin PDIP (Only for MC9S08QD4 and MC9S08QD2) All package options are RoHS compliant MC9S08QD4 Data Sheet Covers: MC9S08QD4 MC9S08QD2 S9S08QD4 S9S08QD2 MC9S08QD4 Rev. 3 11/2007 Revision History To provide the most up-to-date information, the revision of our documents on the World Wide Web will be the most current. Your printed copy may be an earlier revision. To verify you have the latest information available, refer to: http://freescale.com/ The following revision history table summarizes changes contained in this document. Revision Number Revision Date 1 15 Sep 06 Initial public release 2 09 Jan 07 Added MC9S08QD2 information; added “M” temperature range (–40 °C to 125 °C); updated temperature sensor equation in the ADC chapter. 3 19 Nov. 07 Added S9S08QD4 and S9S08QD2 information for automotive applications. Revised "Accessing (read or write) any flash control register..." to “ Writing any flash control register...” in Section 4.5.5, “Access Errors.” Description of Changes This product incorporates SuperFlash® technology licensed from SST. Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. © Freescale Semiconductor, Inc., 2007. All rights reserved. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 6 Freescale Semiconductor List of Chapters Chapter 1 Device Overview ...................................................................... 17 Chapter 2 External Signal Description .................................................... 21 Chapter 3 Modes of Operation ................................................................. 27 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition .................................... 33 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control.................. 53 Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control.................................................. 69 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) ...................................... 75 Chapter 8 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC10V1) ................................ 95 Chapter 9 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1)........................................ 123 Chapter 10 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV2) ............................................ 137 Chapter 11 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) ......................... 145 Chapter 12 Development Support ........................................................... 161 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics...................................................... 175 Appendix B Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings................ 193 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 7 Contents Section Number Title Page Chapter 1 Device Overview 1.1 1.2 1.3 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................17 Devices in the MC9S08QD4 Series ................................................................................................17 1.2.1 MCU Block Diagram ........................................................................................................19 System Clock Distribution ..............................................................................................................20 Chapter 2 External Signal Description 2.1 2.2 Device Pin Assignment ...................................................................................................................21 Recommended System Connections ...............................................................................................21 2.2.1 Power ................................................................................................................................22 2.2.2 Oscillator ...........................................................................................................................23 2.2.3 Reset (Input Only) ............................................................................................................23 2.2.4 Background / Mode Select (BKGD/MS) ..........................................................................23 2.2.5 General-Purpose I/O and Peripheral Ports ........................................................................24 Chapter 3 Modes of Operation 3.1 3.2 3.3 3.4 3.5 3.6 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................27 Features ...........................................................................................................................................27 Run Mode ........................................................................................................................................27 Active Background Mode ...............................................................................................................27 Wait Mode .......................................................................................................................................28 Stop Modes ......................................................................................................................................28 3.6.1 Stop2 Mode .......................................................................................................................29 3.6.2 Stop3 Mode .......................................................................................................................30 3.6.3 Active BDM Enabled in Stop Mode .................................................................................30 3.6.4 LVD Enabled in Stop Mode ..............................................................................................31 3.6.5 On-Chip Peripheral Modules in Stop Modes ....................................................................31 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 4.1 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.5 MC9S08QD4 Series Memory Maps ...............................................................................................33 Reset and Interrupt Vector Assignments .........................................................................................34 Register Addresses and Bit Assignments ........................................................................................35 RAM ................................................................................................................................................38 Flash ................................................................................................................................................39 4.5.1 Features .............................................................................................................................39 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 9 4.6 4.7 4.5.2 Program and Erase Times .................................................................................................39 4.5.3 Program and Erase Command Execution .........................................................................40 4.5.4 Burst Program Execution ..................................................................................................41 4.5.5 Access Errors ....................................................................................................................43 4.5.6 Flash Block Protection ......................................................................................................44 4.5.7 Vector Redirection ............................................................................................................45 Security ............................................................................................................................................45 Flash Registers and Control Bits .....................................................................................................46 4.7.1 Flash Clock Divider Register (FCDIV) ............................................................................46 4.7.2 Flash Options Register (FOPT and NVOPT) ....................................................................48 4.7.3 Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG) ...........................................................................49 4.7.4 Flash Protection Register (FPROT and NVPROT) ..........................................................49 4.7.5 Flash Status Register (FSTAT) ..........................................................................................50 4.7.6 Flash Command Register (FCMD) ...................................................................................51 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.1 5.2 5.3 5.4 5.5 5.6 5.7 5.8 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................53 Features ...........................................................................................................................................53 MCU Reset ......................................................................................................................................53 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Watchdog .............................................................................54 Interrupts .........................................................................................................................................55 5.5.1 Interrupt Stack Frame .......................................................................................................56 5.5.2 External Interrupt Request (IRQ) Pin ...............................................................................56 5.5.3 Interrupt Vectors, Sources, and Local Masks ...................................................................57 Low-Voltage Detect (LVD) System ................................................................................................58 5.6.1 Power-On Reset Operation ...............................................................................................59 5.6.2 LVD Reset Operation ........................................................................................................59 5.6.3 LVD Interrupt Operation ...................................................................................................59 5.6.4 Low-Voltage Warning (LVW) ...........................................................................................59 Real-Time Interrupt (RTI) ...............................................................................................................59 Reset, Interrupt, and System Control Registers and Control Bits ...................................................60 5.8.1 Interrupt Pin Request Status and Control Register (IRQSC) ............................................60 5.8.2 System Reset Status Register (SRS) .................................................................................61 5.8.3 System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) ............................................62 5.8.4 System Options Register 1 (SOPT1) ................................................................................63 5.8.5 System Options Register 2 (SOPT2) ................................................................................64 5.8.6 System Device Identification Register (SDIDH, SDIDL) ................................................64 5.8.7 System Real-Time Interrupt Status and Control Register (SRTISC) ................................65 5.8.8 System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1) ...........................66 5.8.9 System Power Management Status and Control 2 Register (SPMSC2) ...........................67 Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control 6.1 Port Data and Data Direction ..........................................................................................................69 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 10 Freescale Semiconductor 6.2 6.3 6.4 Pin Control — Pullup, Slew Rate and Drive Strength ....................................................................70 Pin Behavior in Stop Modes ............................................................................................................70 Parallel I/O Registers ......................................................................................................................71 6.4.1 Port A Registers ................................................................................................................71 6.4.2 Port A Control Registers ...................................................................................................72 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.1 7.2 7.3 7.4 7.5 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................75 7.1.1 Features .............................................................................................................................75 Programmer’s Model and CPU Registers .......................................................................................76 7.2.1 Accumulator (A) ...............................................................................................................76 7.2.2 Index Register (H:X) ........................................................................................................76 7.2.3 Stack Pointer (SP) .............................................................................................................77 7.2.4 Program Counter (PC) ......................................................................................................77 7.2.5 Condition Code Register (CCR) .......................................................................................77 Addressing Modes ...........................................................................................................................79 7.3.1 Inherent Addressing Mode (INH) .....................................................................................79 7.3.2 Relative Addressing Mode (REL) ....................................................................................79 7.3.3 Immediate Addressing Mode (IMM) ................................................................................79 7.3.4 Direct Addressing Mode (DIR) ........................................................................................79 7.3.5 Extended Addressing Mode (EXT) ..................................................................................80 7.3.6 Indexed Addressing Mode ................................................................................................80 Special Operations ...........................................................................................................................81 7.4.1 Reset Sequence .................................................................................................................81 7.4.2 Interrupt Sequence ............................................................................................................81 7.4.3 Wait Mode Operation ........................................................................................................82 7.4.4 Stop Mode Operation ........................................................................................................82 7.4.5 BGND Instruction .............................................................................................................83 HCS08 Instruction Set Summary ....................................................................................................84 Chapter 8 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC10V1) 8.1 8.2 8.3 Introduction .....................................................................................................................................95 8.1.1 Module Configurations .....................................................................................................96 8.1.2 Features .............................................................................................................................99 8.1.3 Block Diagram ..................................................................................................................99 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................100 8.2.1 Analog Power (VDDAD) ..................................................................................................101 8.2.2 Analog Ground (VSSAD) .................................................................................................101 8.2.3 Voltage Reference High (VREFH) ...................................................................................101 8.2.4 Voltage Reference Low (VREFL) ....................................................................................101 8.2.5 Analog Channel Inputs (ADx) ........................................................................................101 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................101 8.3.1 Status and Control Register 1 (ADCSC1) ......................................................................101 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 11 8.4 8.5 8.6 8.3.2 Status and Control Register 2 (ADCSC2) ......................................................................103 8.3.3 Data Result High Register (ADCRH) .............................................................................104 8.3.4 Data Result Low Register (ADCRL) ..............................................................................104 8.3.5 Compare Value High Register (ADCCVH) ....................................................................105 8.3.6 Compare Value Low Register (ADCCVL) .....................................................................105 8.3.7 Configuration Register (ADCCFG) ................................................................................105 8.3.8 Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1) ..................................................................................107 8.3.9 Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2) ..................................................................................108 8.3.10 Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3) ..................................................................................109 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................110 8.4.1 Clock Select and Divide Control ....................................................................................110 8.4.2 Input Select and Pin Control ...........................................................................................111 8.4.3 Hardware Trigger ............................................................................................................ 111 8.4.4 Conversion Control ......................................................................................................... 111 8.4.5 Automatic Compare Function .........................................................................................114 8.4.6 MCU Wait Mode Operation ............................................................................................114 8.4.7 MCU Stop3 Mode Operation ..........................................................................................114 8.4.8 MCU Stop1 and Stop2 Mode Operation .........................................................................115 Initialization Information ..............................................................................................................115 8.5.1 ADC Module Initialization Example .............................................................................115 Application Information ................................................................................................................117 8.6.1 External Pins and Routing ..............................................................................................117 8.6.2 Sources of Error ..............................................................................................................119 Chapter 9 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.1 9.2 9.3 9.4 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................123 9.1.1 ICS Configuration Information .......................................................................................123 9.1.2 Features ...........................................................................................................................125 9.1.3 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................125 9.1.4 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................126 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................127 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................127 9.3.1 ICS Control Register 1 (ICSC1) .....................................................................................127 9.3.2 ICS Control Register 2 (ICSC2) .....................................................................................128 9.3.3 ICS Trim Register (ICSTRM) .........................................................................................129 9.3.4 ICS Status and Control (ICSSC) .....................................................................................129 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................130 9.4.1 Operational Modes ..........................................................................................................130 9.4.2 Mode Switching ..............................................................................................................132 9.4.3 Bus Frequency Divider ...................................................................................................132 9.4.4 Low Power Bit Usage .....................................................................................................133 9.4.5 Internal Reference Clock ................................................................................................133 9.4.6 Optional External Reference Clock ................................................................................133 9.4.7 Fixed Frequency Clock ...................................................................................................134 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 12 Freescale Semiconductor 9.5 Module Initialization ....................................................................................................................134 9.5.1 ICS Module Initialization Sequence ...............................................................................134 Chapter 10 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV2) 10.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................137 10.1.1 Features ...........................................................................................................................139 10.1.2 Modes of Operation ........................................................................................................139 10.1.3 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................139 10.2 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................140 10.3 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................140 10.3.1 KBI Status and Control Register (KBISC) .....................................................................140 10.3.2 KBI Pin Enable Register (KBIPE) ..................................................................................141 10.3.3 KBI Edge Select Register (KBIES) ................................................................................141 10.4 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................142 10.4.1 Edge Only Sensitivity .....................................................................................................142 10.4.2 Edge and Level Sensitivity .............................................................................................142 10.4.3 KBI Pullup/Pulldown Resistors ......................................................................................143 10.4.4 KBI Initialization ............................................................................................................143 Chapter 11 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) 11.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................145 11.1.1 TPM2 Configuration Information ...................................................................................145 11.1.2 TCLK1 and TCLK2 Configuration Information ............................................................145 11.1.3 Features ...........................................................................................................................147 11.1.4 Block Diagram ................................................................................................................147 11.2 External Signal Description ..........................................................................................................149 11.2.1 External TPM Clock Sources .........................................................................................149 11.2.2 TPMxCHn — TPMx Channel n I/O Pins .......................................................................149 11.3 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................149 11.3.1 Timer Status and Control Register (TPMxSC) ...............................................................150 11.3.2 Timer Counter Registers (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL) ...................................................151 11.3.3 Timer Counter Modulo Registers (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL) ..................................152 11.3.4 Timer Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC) .........................................153 11.3.5 Timer Channel Value Registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) .........................................154 11.4 Functional Description ..................................................................................................................155 11.4.1 Counter ............................................................................................................................155 11.4.2 Channel Mode Selection .................................................................................................156 11.4.3 Center-Aligned PWM Mode ...........................................................................................158 11.5 TPM Interrupts ..............................................................................................................................159 11.5.1 Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags .......................................................................................159 11.5.2 Timer Overflow Interrupt Description ............................................................................159 11.5.3 Channel Event Interrupt Description ..............................................................................160 11.5.4 PWM End-of-Duty-Cycle Events ...................................................................................160 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 13 Chapter 12 Development Support 12.1 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................161 12.1.1 Forcing Active Background ............................................................................................161 12.1.2 Module Configuration .....................................................................................................161 12.1.3 Features ...........................................................................................................................162 12.2 Background Debug Controller (BDC) ..........................................................................................162 12.2.1 BKGD Pin Description ...................................................................................................163 12.2.2 Communication Details ..................................................................................................163 12.2.3 BDC Commands .............................................................................................................166 12.2.4 BDC Hardware Breakpoint .............................................................................................169 12.3 Register Definition ........................................................................................................................169 12.3.1 BDC Registers and Control Bits .....................................................................................170 12.3.2 System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) ..........................................172 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics A.1 A.2 A.3 A.4 A.5 A.6 A.7 A.8 Introduction ...................................................................................................................................175 Absolute Maximum Ratings ..........................................................................................................175 Thermal Characteristics .................................................................................................................176 ESD Protection and Latch-Up Immunity ......................................................................................177 DC Characteristics .........................................................................................................................177 Supply Current Characteristics ......................................................................................................184 Internal Clock Source Characteristics ...........................................................................................186 AC Characteristics .........................................................................................................................188 A.8.1 Control Timing ...............................................................................................................188 A.8.2 Timer/PWM (TPM) Module Timing ..............................................................................189 A.9 ADC Characteristics ......................................................................................................................190 A.10 Flash Specifications .......................................................................................................................191 Appendix B Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings B.1 Ordering Information ....................................................................................................................193 B.1.1 Device Numbering Scheme ............................................................................................193 B.2 Mechanical Drawings ....................................................................................................................194 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 14 Freescale Semiconductor MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 15 Chapter 1 Device Overview 1.1 Introduction MC9S08QD4 series MCUs are members of the low-cost, high-performance HCS08 family of 8-bit microcontroller units (MCUs). All MCUs in the family use the enhanced HCS08 core and are available with a variety of modules, memory sizes, memory types, and package types. 1.2 Devices in the MC9S08QD4 Series This data sheet covers: • MC9S08QD4 • MC9S08QD2 • S9S08QD4 • S9S08QD2 • • NOTE The MC9S08QD4 and MC9S08QD2 devices are qualified for, and are intended to be used in, consumer and industrial applications. The S9S08QD4 and S9S08QD2 devices are qualified for, and are intended to be used in, automotive applications. Table 1-1 summarizes the features available in the MCUs. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 17 Chapter 1 Device Overview Table 1-1. Features by MCU and Package Consumer and Industrial Devices Feature MC9S08QD4 MC9S08QD2 Flash 4 KB 2 KB RAM 256 B 128 B ADC 4-ch, 10-bit Bus speed 8 MHz at 5 V Operating voltage 2.7 to 5.5 V 16-bit Timer One 1-ch; one 2-ch GPIO Four I/O; one input-only; one output-only LVI Yes Package options 8-pin PDIP; 8-pin NB SOIC Consumer & Industrial Qualified yes yes Automotive Qualified no no Automotive Devices Feature S9S08QD4 S9S08QD2 Flash 4 KB 2 KB RAM 256 B 128 B ADC 4-ch, 10-bit Bus speed 8 MHz at 5 V Operating voltage 2.7 to 5.5 V 16-bit Timer One 1-ch; one 2-ch GPIO Four I/O; one input-only; one output-only LVI Yes Package options 8-pin NB SOIC Consumer & Industrial Qualified no no Automotive Qualified yes yes MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 18 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 1 Device Overview 1.2.1 MCU Block Diagram BKGD/MS IRQ HCS08 CORE BDC 4-BIT KEYBOARD INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI) HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT RTI COP IRQ LVD USER FLASH 4096 / 2048 BYTES 4 TPM2CH0 1-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) TCLK2 2-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) TPM1CH0 TPM1CH1 TCLK1 10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) PORT A CPU PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS PTA3/KBI1P3/TCLK2/ADC1P3 PTA2/KBI1P2/TCLK1/ADC1P2 PTA1/KBI1P1/TPM1CH1/ADC1P1 PTA0/KBI1P0/TPM1CH0/ADC1P0 4 USER RAM 256 / 128 BYTES 16 MHz INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE (ICS) VSS VDD VOLTAGE REGULATOR VDDA VSSA VREFH VREFL NOTES: 1 Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port. 2 Port pins are software configurable for output drive strength. 3 Port pins are software configurable for output slew rate control. 4 IRQ contains a software configurable (IRQPDD) pullup/pulldown device if PTA5 enabled as IRQ pin function (IRQPE = 1). 5 RESET contains integrated pullup device if PTA5 enabled as reset pin function (RSTPE = 1). 6 PTA5 does not contain a clamp diode to V DD and must not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on this pin when internal pullup is enabled may be as low as VDD – 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled to VDD. 7 PTA4 contains integrated pullup device if BKGD enabled (BKGDPE = 1). 8 When pin functions as KBI (KBIPEn = 1) and associated pin is configured to enable the pullup device, KBEDGn can be used to reconfigure the pullup as a pulldown device. Figure 1-1. MC9S08QD4 Series Block Diagram Table 1-2 provides the functional versions of the on-chip modules. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 19 Chapter 1 Device Overview Table 1-2. Versions of On-Chip Modules Module Version Analog-to-Digital Converter 1.3 (ADC) 1 Central Processing Unit (CPU) 2 Internal Clock Source (ICS) 1 Keyboard Interrupt (KBI) 2 Timer Pulse-Width Modulator (TPM) 2 System Clock Distribution Figure 1-2 shows a simplified clock connection diagram. Some modules in the MCU have selectable clock inputs as shown. The clock inputs to the modules indicate the clock(s) that are used to drive the module function. All memory mapped registers associated with the modules are clocked with BUSCLK. TCLK1 TCLK2 TPM1 TPM2 SYSTEM CONTROL LOGIC RTI ICSIRCLK ICSFFCLK ICS COP FIXED FREQ CLOCK (XCLK) ÷2 ICSOUT ÷2 BUSCLK CPU ICSLCLK1 BDC FLASH3 ADC2 1 ICSLCLK is the alternate BDC clock source for the MC9S08QD4 series. 2 ADC has min. and max frequency requirements. See ADC chapter and Appendix A, “Electrical Characteristics.” 3 Flash has frequency requirements for program and erase operation.See Appendix A, “Electrical Characteristics.” Figure 1-2. System Clock Distribution Diagram MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 20 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 2 External Signal Description This chapter describes signals that connect to package pins. It includes pinout diagrams, table of signal properties, and detailed discussions of signals. 2.1 Device Pin Assignment Figure 2-1 shows the pin assignments for the 8-pin packages. PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET 1 8 PTA0/KBI1P0/TPM1CH0/ADC1P0 PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS 2 7 PTA1/KBI1P1/TPM1CH1/ADC1P1 VDD 3 6 PTA2/KBI1P2/TCLK1/ADC1P2 VSS 4 5 PTA3/KBI1P3/TCLK2/ADC1P3 Figure 2-1. 8-Pin Packages 2.2 Recommended System Connections Figure 2-2 shows pin connections that are common to almost all MC9S08QD4 series application systems. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 21 Chapter 2 External Signal Description MC9S08QD4 VDD SYSTEM POWER + 5V CBLK + 10 μF PTA0/KBI1P0/TPM1CH0/ADC1P0 VDD CBY PTA1/KBI1P1/TPM1CH1/ADC1P1 PORT A 0.1 μF VSS PTA2/KBI1P2/TCLK1/ADC1P2 PTA3/KBI1P3/TCLK2/ADC1P3 PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET I/O AND PERIPHERAL INTERFACE TO APPLICATION SYSTEM BACKGROUND HEADER BKGD VDD NOTE 1 OPTIONAL MANUAL RESET ASYNCHRONOUS INTERRUPT INPUT RESET IRQ NOTE 2 NOTES: 1. RESET pin can only be used to reset into user mode, you can not enter BDM using RESET pin. BDM can be entered by holding MS low during POR or writing a 1 to BDFR in SBDFR with MS low after issuing BDM command. 2. IRQ has optional internal pullup/pulldown device Figure 2-2. Basic System Connections 2.2.1 Power VDD and VSS are the primary power supply pins for the MCU. This voltage source supplies power to all I/O buffer circuitry, the ADC module, and to an internal voltage regulator. The internal voltage regulator provides regulated lower-voltage source to the CPU and other internal circuitry of the MCU. Typically, application systems have two separate capacitors across the power pins: a bulk electrolytic capacitor, such as a 10μF tantalum capacitor, to provide bulk charge storage for the overall system, and a bypass capacitor, such as a 0.1μF ceramic capacitor, located as near to the MCU power pins as practical to suppress high-frequency noise. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 22 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 2 External Signal Description 2.2.2 Oscillator Out of reset the MCU uses an internally generated clock provided by the internal clock source (ICS) module. The internal frequency is nominally 16 MHz and the default ICS settings will provide for a 4 MHz bus out of reset. For more information on the ICS, see the Internal Clock Source chapter. 2.2.3 Reset (Input Only) After a power-on reset (POR) into user mode, the PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET pin defaults to a general-purpose input port pin, PTA5. Setting RSTPE in SOPT1 configures the pin to be the RESET input pin. Once configured as RESET, the pin will remain RESET until the next POR. The RESET pin can be used to reset the MCU from an external source when the pin is driven low. When enabled as the RESET pin (RSTPE = 1), an internal pullup device is automatically enabled. After a POR into active background mode, the PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET pin defaults to the RESET pin. When TPM2 is configured for input capture, the pin will be the input capture pin TPM2CH0I. NOTE This pin does not contain a clamp diode to VDD and must not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on the internally pulled up RESET pin may be as low as VDD – 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled to VDD. 2.2.4 Background / Mode Select (BKGD/MS) During a power-on-reset (POR) or background debug force reset (see Section 5.8.3, “System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR)” for more information), the PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS pin functions as a mode select pin. Immediately after any reset, the pin functions as the background pin and can be used for background debug communication. When enabled as the BKGD/MS pin (BKGDPE = 1), an internal pullup device is automatically enabled. The background debug communication function is enabled when BKGDPE in SOPT1 is set. BKGDPE is set following any reset of the MCU and must be cleared to use the PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS pins alternative pin functions. If nothing is connected to this pin, the MCU will enter normal operating mode at the rising edge of the internal reset after a POR or force BDC reset. If a debug system is connected to the 6-pin standard background debug header, it can hold BKGD/MS low during a POR or immediately after issuing a background debug force reset, which will force the MCU to active background mode. The BKGD pin is used primarily for background debug controller (BDC) communications using a custom protocol that uses 16 clock cycles of the target MCU’s BDC clock per bit time. The target MCU’s BDC clock could be as fast as the maximum bus clock rate, so there must never be any significant capacitance connected to the BKGD/MS pin that could interfere with background serial communications. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 23 Chapter 2 External Signal Description Although the BKGD pin is a pseudo open-drain pin, the background debug communication protocol provides brief, actively driven, high speedup pulses to ensure fast rise times. Small capacitances from cables and the absolute value of the internal pullup device play almost no role in determining rise and fall times on the BKGD pin. 2.2.5 General-Purpose I/O and Peripheral Ports The MC9S08QD4 series of MCUs support up to 4 general-purpose I/O pins, 1 input-only pin and 1 output-only pin, which are shared with on-chip peripheral functions (timers, serial I/O, ADC, keyboard interrupts, etc.). On each of the MC9S08QD4 series devices there is one input-only and one output-only port pin. When a port pin is configured as a general-purpose output or a peripheral uses the port pin as an output, software can select one of two drive strengths and enable or disable slew rate control. When a port pin is configured as a general-purpose input or a peripheral uses the port pin as an input, software can enable a pullup device. For information about controlling these pins as general-purpose I/O pins, see the Chapter 6, “Parallel Input/Output Control.” For information about how and when on-chip peripheral systems use these pins, see the appropriate chapter referenced in Table 2-1. Immediately after reset, all pins that are not output-only are configured as high-impedance, general-purpose inputs with internal pullup devices disabled. After reset, the output-only port function is not enabled but is configured for low output drive strength with slew rate control enabled. The PTA4 pin defaults to BKGD/MS on any reset. NOTE To avoid extra current drain from floating input pins, the reset initialization routine in the application program must either enable on-chip pullup devices or change the direction of unused pins to outputs so the pins do not float. 2.2.5.1 Pin Control Registers To select drive strength or enable slew rate control or pullup devices, the user writes to the appropriate pin control register located in the high-page register block of the memory map. The pin control registers operate independently of the parallel I/O registers and allow control of a port on an individual pin basis. 2.2.5.1.1 Internal Pullup Enable An internal pullup device can be enabled for each port pin by setting the corresponding bit in one of the pullup enable registers (PTxPEn). The pullup device is disabled if the pin is configured as an output by the parallel I/O control logic or any shared peripheral function, regardless of the state of the corresponding pullup enable register bit. The pullup device is also disabled if the pin is controlled by an analog function. The KBI module and IRQ function when enabled for rising edge detection causes an enabled internal pull device to be configured as a pulldown. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 24 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 2 External Signal Description 2.2.5.2 Output Slew Rate Control Slew rate control can be enabled for each port pin by setting the corresponding bit in one of the slew rate control registers (PTxSEn). When enabled, slew control limits the rate at which an output can transition in order to reduce EMC emissions. Slew rate control has no effect on pins that are configured as inputs. 2.2.5.3 Output Drive Strength Select An output pin can be selected to have high output drive strength by setting the corresponding bit in one of the drive strength select registers (PTxDSn). When high drive is selected, a pin is capable of sourcing and sinking greater current. Even though every I/O pin can be selected as high drive, the user must ensure that the total current source and sink limits for the chip are not exceeded. Drive strength selection is intended to affect the DC behavior of I/O pins. However, the AC behavior is also affected. High drive allows a pin to drive a greater load with the same switching speed as a low drive enabled pin into a smaller load. Because of this, the EMC emissions may be affected by enabling pins as high drive. Table 2-1. Pin Sharing Priority Lowest <- Pin Function Priority -> Highest Port Pins PTA0 PTA1 PTA2 PTA3 PTA4 PTA52 Alternative Function KBI1P0 KBI1P1 KBI1P2 KBI1P3 TPM2CH0O TPM2CH0I Alternative Function TPM1CH0 TPM1CH1 TCLK1 TCLK2 BKGD/MS IRQ Reference1 Alternative Function ADC1P03 ADC1P13 ADC1P23 ADC1P33 RESET KBI1, ADC1, and TPM1 Chapters KBI1, ADC1, and TPM1 Chapters KBI1, ADC1, and TPM1 Chapters KBI1, ADC1, and TPM2 Chapters TPM2 Chapters IRQ4, and TPM2 Chapters 1 See the module section listed for information on modules that share these pins. Pin does not contain a clamp diode to VDD and must not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on this pin when internal pullup is enabled may be as low as VDD – 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled to VDD. 3 If both of these analog modules are enabled both will have access to the pin. 4 See Section 5.8, “Reset, Interrupt, and System Control Registers and Control Bits,” for information on configuring the IRQ module. 2 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 25 Chapter 2 External Signal Description MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 26 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 3 Modes of Operation 3.1 Introduction The operating modes of the MC9S08QD4 series are described in this chapter. Entry into each mode, exit from each mode, and functionality while in each of the modes are described. 3.2 • • • 3.3 Features Active background mode for code development Wait mode: — CPU shuts down to conserve power — System clocks running — Full voltage regulation maintained Stop modes: — CPU and bus clocks stopped — Stop2 — Partial power down of internal circuits, RAM contents retained — Stop3 — All internal circuits powered for fast recovery Run Mode This is the normal operating mode for the MC9S08QD4 series. This mode is selected when the BKGD/MS pin is high at the rising edge of reset. In this mode, the CPU executes code from internal memory with execution beginning at the address fetched from memory at 0xFFFE:0xFFFF after reset. 3.4 Active Background Mode The active background mode functions are managed through the background debug controller (BDC) in the HCS08 core. The BDC provides the means for analyzing MCU operation during software development. Active background mode is entered in any of five ways: • When the BKGD/MS pin is low at the rising edge of reset • When a BACKGROUND command is received through the BKGD pin • When a BGND instruction is executed • When encountering a BDC breakpoint MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 27 Chapter 3 Modes of Operation After entering active background mode, the CPU is held in a suspended state waiting for serial background commands rather than executing instructions from the user’s application program. Background commands are of two types: • Non-intrusive commands, defined as commands that can be issued while the user program is running. Non-intrusive commands can be issued through the BKGD pin while the MCU is in run mode; non-intrusive commands can also be executed when the MCU is in the active background mode. Non-intrusive commands include: — Memory access commands — Memory-access-with-status commands — BDC register access commands — The BACKGROUND command • Active background commands, which can only be executed while the MCU is in active background mode. Active background commands include commands to: — Read or write CPU registers — Trace one user program instruction at a time — Leave active background mode to return to the user’s application program (GO) The active background mode is used to program a bootloader or user application program into the flash program memory before the MCU is operated in run mode for the first time. When MC9S08QD4 series devices are shipped from the Freescale Semiconductor factory, the flash program memory is erased by default unless specifically noted, so no program can be executed in run mode until the flash memory is initially programmed. The active background mode can also be used to erase and reprogram the flash memory after it has been previously programmed. For additional information about the active background mode, refer to Chapter 12, “Development Support.” 3.5 Wait Mode Wait mode is entered by executing a WAIT instruction. Upon execution of the WAIT instruction, the CPU enters a low-power state in which it is not clocked. The I bit in CCR is cleared when the CPU enters the wait mode, enabling interrupts. When an interrupt request occurs, the CPU exits the wait mode and resumes processing, beginning with the stacking operations leading to the interrupt service routine. While the MCU is in wait mode, there are some restrictions on which background debug commands can be used. Only the BACKGROUND command and memory-access-with-status commands are available when the MCU is in wait mode. The memory-access-with-status commands do not allow memory access, but they report an error indicating that the MCU is in either stop or wait mode. The BACKGROUND command can be used to wake the MCU from wait mode and enter active background mode. 3.6 Stop Modes One of two stop modes is entered upon execution of a STOP instruction when the STOPE bit in the system option register is set. In both stop modes, all internal clocks are halted. If the STOPE bit is not set when MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 28 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 3 Modes of Operation the CPU executes a STOP instruction, the MCU will not enter either of the stop modes and an illegal opcode reset is forced. The stop modes are selected by setting the appropriate bits in SPMSC2. HCS08 devices that are designed for low voltage operation (1.8V to 3.6V) also include stop1 mode. The MC9S08QD4 series does not include stop1 mode. Table 3-1 summarizes the behavior of the MCU in each of the stop modes. Table 3-1. Stop Mode Behavior 1 Mode PPDC CPU, Digital Peripherals, Flash RAM ICS ADC1 Regulator I/O Pins RTI Stop2 1 Off Standby Off Disabled Standby States held Optionally on Stop3 0 Standby Standby Off1 Optionally on Standby States held Optionally on ICS can be configured to run in stop3. Please see the ICS registers. 3.6.1 Stop2 Mode The stop2 mode provides very low standby power consumption and maintains the contents of RAM and the current state of all of the I/O pins. To enter stop2, the user must execute a STOP instruction with stop2 selected (PPDC = 1) and stop mode enabled (STOPE = 1). In addition, the LVD must not be enabled to operate in stop (LVDSE = 0 or LVDE = 0). If the LVD is enabled in stop, then the MCU enters stop3 upon the execution of the STOP instruction regardless of the state of PPDC. Before entering stop2 mode, the user must save the contents of the I/O port registers, as well as any other memory-mapped registers which they want to restore after exit of stop2, to locations in RAM. Upon exit of stop2, these values can be restored by user software before pin latches are opened. When the MCU is in stop2 mode, all internal circuits that are powered from the voltage regulator are turned off, except for the RAM. The voltage regulator is in a low-power standby state, as is the ADC. Upon entry into stop2, the states of the I/O pins are latched. The states are held while in stop2 mode and after exiting stop2 mode until a logic 1 is written to PPDACK in SPMSC2. Exit from stop2 is done by asserting either of the wake-up pins: RESET or IRQ, or by an RTI interrupt. IRQ is always an active low input when the MCU is in stop2, regardless of how it was configured before entering stop2. NOTE Although this IRQ pin is automatically configured as active low input, the pullup associated with the IRQ pin is not automatically enabled. Therefore, if an external pullup is not used, the internal pullup must be enabled by setting IRQPE in IRQSC. Upon wake-up from stop2 mode, the MCU will start up as from a power-on reset (POR) except pin states remain latched. The CPU will take the reset vector. The system and all peripherals will be in their default reset states and must be initialized. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 29 Chapter 3 Modes of Operation After waking up from stop2, the PPDF bit in SPMSC2 is set. This flag may be used to direct user code to go to a stop2 recovery routine. PPDF remains set and the I/O pin states remain latched until a logic 1 is written to PPDACK in SPMSC2. To maintain I/O state for pins that were configured as general-purpose I/O, the user must restore the contents of the I/O port registers, which have been saved in RAM, to the port registers before writing to the PPDACK bit. If the port registers are not restored from RAM before writing to PPDACK, then the register bits will assume their reset states when the I/O pin latches are opened and the I/O pins will switch to their reset states. For pins that were configured as peripheral I/O, the user must reconfigure the peripheral module that interfaces to the pin before writing to the PPDACK bit. If the peripheral module is not enabled before writing to PPDACK, the pins will be controlled by their associated port control registers when the I/O latches are opened. 3.6.2 Stop3 Mode Stop3 mode is entered by executing a STOP instruction under the conditions as shown in Table 3-1. The states of all of the internal registers and logic, RAM contents, and I/O pin states are maintained. Stop3 can be exited by asserting RESET, or by an interrupt from one of the following sources: the real-time interrupt (RTI), LVD, ADC, IRQ, or the KBI. If stop3 is exited by means of the RESET pin, then the MCU is reset and operation will resume after taking the reset vector. Exit by means of one of the internal interrupt sources results in the MCU taking the appropriate interrupt vector. 3.6.3 Active BDM Enabled in Stop Mode Entry into the active background mode from run mode is enabled if the ENBDM bit in BDCSCR is set. This register is described in Chapter 12, “Development Support,” of this data sheet. If ENBDM is set when the CPU executes a STOP instruction, the system clocks to the background debug logic remain active when the MCU enters stop mode so background debug communication is still possible. In addition, the voltage regulator does not enter its low-power standby state but maintains full internal regulation. If the user attempts to enter stop2 with ENBDM set, the MCU will instead enter stop3. Most background commands are not available in stop mode. The memory-access-with-status commands do not allow memory access, but they report an error indicating that the MCU is in either stop or wait mode. The BACKGROUND command can be used to wake the MCU from stop and enter active background mode if the ENBDM bit is set. After entering background debug mode, all background commands are available. Table 3-2 summarizes the behavior of the MCU in stop when entry into the background debug mode is enabled. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 30 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 3 Modes of Operation Table 3-2. BDM Enabled Stop Mode Behavior Mode PPDC CPU, Digital Peripherals, Flash RAM ICS ADC1 Regulator I/O Pins RTI Stop3 0 Standby Standby Active Optionally on Active States held Optionally on 3.6.4 LVD Enabled in Stop Mode The LVD system is capable of generating either an interrupt or a reset when the supply voltage drops below the LVD voltage. If the LVD is enabled in stop by setting the LVDE and the LVDSE bits, then the voltage regulator remains active during stop mode. If the user attempts to enter stop2 with the LVD enabled for stop, the MCU will instead enter stop3. Table 3-3 summarizes the behavior of the MCU in stop when the LVD is enabled. Table 3-3. LVD Enabled Stop Mode Behavior 1 Mode PPDC CPU, Digital Peripherals, Flash RAM ICS ADC1 Regulator I/O Pins RTI Stop3 0 Standby Standby Off1 Optionally on Active States held Optionally on ICS can be configured to run in stop3. Please see the ICS registers. 3.6.5 On-Chip Peripheral Modules in Stop Modes When the MCU enters any stop mode, system clocks to the internal peripheral modules are stopped. Even in the exception case (ENBDM = 1), where clocks to the background debug logic continue to operate, clocks to the peripheral systems are halted to reduce power consumption. Refer to Section 3.6.1, “Stop2 Mode,” and Section 3.6.2, “Stop3 Mode,” for specific information on system behavior in stop modes. Table 3-4. Stop Mode Behavior Mode Peripheral Stop2 CPU Off Standby RAM Standby Standby Flash Off Standby Parallel Port Registers Off Standby ADC1 Off Optionally On1 ICS Off Standby TPM1 & TPM2 Voltage Regulator I/O Pins 1 Stop3 Off Standby Standby Standby States Held States Held Requires the asynchronous ADC clock and LVD to be enabled, else in standby. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 31 Chapter 3 Modes of Operation MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 32 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 4.1 MC9S08QD4 Series Memory Maps As shown in Figure 4-1, on-chip memory in the MC9S08QD4 series MCU consists of RAM, flash program memory for non-volatile data storage, and I/O and control/status registers. The registers are divided into these groups: • Direct-page registers (0x0000 through 0x005F) • High-page registers (0x1800 through 0x184F) • Non-volatile registers (0xFFB0 through 0xFFBF) 0x0000 0x005F 0x0060 0x015F 0x0160 0x17FF 0x1800 DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS RAM 256 BYTES UNIMPLEMENTED 5,792 BYTES 0x0000 0x005F 0x0060–0x07F DIRECT PAGE REGISTERS RESERVED — 32 BYTES 0x0080–0x0FF RAM — 128 BYTES 0x0100–0x015F RESERVED — 96 BYTES 0x17FF 0x1800 UNIMPLEMENTED 5,792 BYTES HIGH PAGE REGISTERS HIGH PAGE REGISTERS 0x184F 0x1850 0x184F 0x1850 UNIMPLEMENTED UNIMPLEMENTED 55,216 BYTES 55,216 BYTES 0xEFFF 0xF000 0xEFFF 0xF000 FLASH 4096 BYTES 0xF7FF 0xF800 0xFFFF 0xFFFF MC9S08QD4 RESERVED — 2048 BYTES FLASH 2048 BYTES MC9S08QD2 Figure 4-1. MC9S08QD4 Series Memory Maps MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 33 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 4.2 Reset and Interrupt Vector Assignments Table 4-1 shows address assignments for reset and interrupt vectors. The vector names shown in this table are the labels used in the Freescale Semiconductor-provided equate file for the MC9S08QD4 series. Table 4-1. Reset and Interrupt Vectors Address (High/Low) 0xFFC0:FFC1 Vector Vector Name Unused Vector Space (available for user program) 0xFFCE:FFCF 0xFFD0:FFD1 RTI Vrti 0xFFD2:FFD3 Reserved — 0xFFD4:FFD5 Reserved — 0xFFD6:FFD7 Reserved — 0xFFD8:FFD9 ADC1 Conversion Vadc1 0xFFDA:FFDB KBI Interrupt Vkeyboard1 0xFFDC:FFDD Reserved — 0xFFDE:FFDF Reserved — 0xFFE0:FFE1 Reserved — 0xFFE2:FFE3 Reserved — 0xFFE4:FFE5 Reserved — 0xFFE6:FFE7 Reserved — 0xFFE8:FFE9 Reserved — 0xFFEA:FFEB TPM2 Overflow Vtpm2ovf 0xFFEC:FFED Reserved — 0xFFEE:FFEF TPM2 Channel 0 Vtpm2ch0 0xFFF0:FFF1 TPM1 Overflow Vtpm1ovf 0xFFF2:FFF3 TPM1 Channel 1 Vtpm1ch1 0xFFF4:FFF5 TPM1 Channel 0 Vtpm1ch0 0xFFF6:FFF7 Reserved — 0xFFF8:FFF9 IRQ IRQ 0xFFFA:FFFB Low Voltage Detect Vlvd 0xFFFC:FFFD SWI Vswi 0xFFFE:FFFF Reset Vreset MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 34 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 4.3 Register Addresses and Bit Assignments The registers in the MC9S08QD4 series are divided into these groups: • Direct-page registers are located in the first 96 locations in the memory map; these are accessible with efficient direct addressing mode instructions. • High-page registers are used much less often, so they are located above 0x1800 in the memory map. This leaves more room in the direct page for more frequently used registers and RAM. • The nonvolatile register area consists of a block of 16 locations in flash memory at 0xFFB0–0xFFBF. Nonvolatile register locations include: — NVPROT and NVOPT are loaded into working registers at reset — An 8-byte backdoor comparison key that optionally allows a user to gain controlled access to secure memory Because the nonvolatile register locations are flash memory, they must be erased and programmed like other flash memory locations. Direct-page registers can be accessed with efficient direct addressing mode instructions. Bit manipulation instructions can be used to access any bit in any direct-page register. Table 4-2 is a summary of all user-accessible direct-page registers and control bits. The direct page registers in Table 4-2 can use the more efficient direct addressing mode that requires only the lower byte of the address. Because of this, the lower byte of the address in column one is shown in bold text. In Table 4-3 and Table 4-4, the whole address in column one is shown in bold. In Table 4-2, Table 4-3, and Table 4-4, the register names in column two are shown in bold to set them apart from the bit names to the right. Cells that are not associated with named bits are shaded. A shaded cell with a 0 indicates this unused bit always reads as a 0. Shaded cells with dashes indicate unused or reserved bit locations that could read as 1s or 0s. Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary Address Register Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x0000 PTAD 0 0 PTAD5 PTAD4 PTAD3 PTAD2 PTAD1 PTAD0 0x0001 PTADD 0 0 PTADD5 PTADD4 PTADD3 PTADD2 PTADD1 PTADD0 0x0002– 0x000B Reserved — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 0x000C KBISC 0 0 0 0 KBF KBACK KBIE KBIMOD 0x000D KBIPE KBIPE7 KBIPE6 KBIPE5 KBIPE4 KBIPE3 KBIPE2 KBIPE1 KBIPE0 0x000E KBIES KBEDG7 KBEDG6 KBEDG5 KBEDG4 KBEDG3 KBEDG2 KBEDG1 KBEDG0 0x000F IRQSC 0 IRQPDD IRQEDG IRQPE IRQF IRQACK IRQIE IRQMOD 0x0010 ADCSC1 COCO AIEN ADCO 0x0011 ADCSC2 ADACT ADTRG ACFE ACFGT — — — — 0x0012 ADCRH 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADR9 ADR8 0x0013 ADCRL ADR7 ADR6 ADR5 ADR4 ADR3 ADR2 ADR1 ADR0 0x0014 ADCCVH 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADCV9 ADCV8 0x0015 ADCCVL ADCV7 ADCV6 ADCV4 ADCV3 ADCV2 ADCV1 ADCV0 0x0016 ADCCFG ADLPC ADCV5 ADIV ADCH ADLSMP MODE ADICLK MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 35 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition Table 4-2. Direct-Page Register Summary (continued) Address Register Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x0017 APCTL1 — — — — ADPC3 ADPC2 ADPC1 ADPC0 0x0018 Reserved — — — — — — — — 0x0019 Reserved — — — — — — — — 0x001A– 0x001F Reserved — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 0x0020 TPM2SC TOF TOIE CPWMS CLKSB CLKSA PS2 PS1 PS0 0x0021 TPM2CNTH Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0x0022 TPM2CNTL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x0023 TPM2MODH Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0x0024 TPM2MODL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x0025 TPM2C0SC CH0F CH0IE MS0B MS0A ELS0B ELS0A 0 0 0x0026 TPM2C0VH Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0x0027 TPM2C0VL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x0028– 0x0037 Reserved — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 0x0038 ICSC1 0 CLKS 0 0 0 1 1 IREFSTEN 0 0 LP 0 0 0 0x0039 ICSC2 0x003A ICSTRM BDIV 0x003B ICSSC 0 0 0 0 0 CLKST 0 FTRIM 0x003C Reserved — — — — — — — — 0x0040 TPMSC TOF TOIE CPWMS CLKSB CLKSA PS2 PS1 PS0 0x0041 TPMCNTH Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0x0042 TPMCNTL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x0043 TPMMODH Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 TRIM 0x0044 TPMMODL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x0045 TPMC0SC CH0F CH0IE MS0B MS0A ELS0B ELS0A 0 0 0x0046 TPMC0VH Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0x0047 TPMC0VL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x0048 TPMC1SC CH1F CH1IE MS1B MS1A ELS1B ELS1A 0 0 0x0049 TPMC1VH Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0x004A TPMC1VL Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0x004B– 0x005F Reserved — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — High-page registers, shown in Table 4-3, are accessed much less often than other I/O and control registers so they have been located outside the direct addressable memory space, starting at 0x1800. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 36 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition Table 4-3. High-Page Register Summary Address 0x1800 Register Name SRS Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 POR PIN COP ILOP ILAD 0 LVD 0 0x1801 SBDFR 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BDFR 0x1802 SOPT1 COPE COPT STOPE 0 0 0 BKGDPE RSTPE 0x1803 SOPT2 COPCLKS 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0x1804 Reserved — — — — — — — — 0x1805 Reserved — — — — — — — — 0x1806 SDIDH REV3 REV2 REV1 REV0 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 0x1807 SDIDL ID7 ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 0x1808 SRTISC RTIF RTIACK RTICLKS RTIE 0 0x1809 SPMSC1 LVDF LVDACK LVDIE LVDRE LVDSE LVDE 01 BGBE 0x180A SPMSC2 LVWF LVWACK LVDV LVWV PPDF PPDACK — PPDC 0x180B– 0x181F Reserved — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 0x1820 FCDIV DIVLD PRDIV8 0x1821 FOPT KEYEN FNORED 0 0 0 0 SEC01 SEC00 0x1822 Reserved — — — — — — — — 0x1823 FCNFG 0 0 KEYACC 0 0 0 0 0 0x1824 FPROT RTIS DIV FPS 0x1825 FSTAT 0x1826 FCMD 0x1827– 0x183F Reserved — — — — — — 0x1840 PTAPE 0 0 PTAPE5 0x1841 PTASE 0 0 PTASE5 PTASE4 PTASE3 PTASE2 PTASE1 PTASE0 0x1842 PTADS 0 0 PTADS5 PTADS4 PTADS3 PTADS2 PTADS1 PTADS0 0x1843– 0x1847 Reserved — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — 1 FCBEF FCCF FPVIOL FPDIS FACCERR 0 FBLANK 0 0 — — — — — — — — — — PTAPE4 PTAPE3 PTAPE2 PTAPE1 PTAPE0 FCMD This reserved bit must always be written to 0. Nonvolatile flash registers, shown in Table 4-4, are located in the flash memory. These registers include an 8-byte backdoor key that optionally can be used to gain access to secure memory resources. During reset events, the contents of NVPROT and NVOPT in the nonvolatile register area of the flash memory are transferred into corresponding FPROT and FOPT working registers in the high-page registers to control security and block protection options. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 37 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition Table 4-4. Nonvolatile Register Summary Address Register Name Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — — Reserved for ADCRL of AD26 value during ICS trim ADR7 ADR6 ADR5 ADR4 ADR3 ADR2 ADR1 ADR0 Reserved for ADCRH of AD26 value during ICS trim and ICS Trim value “FTRIM” ADR9 ADR8 — — — — — FTRIM — — — — — — 0xFFAA – Reserved 0xFFAC 0xFFAD 0xFFAE 0xFFAF Reserved for ICS Trim value “TRIM” TRIM 0xFFB0 – NVBACKKEY 0xFFB7 0xFFB8 – Reserved 0xFFBC 8-Byte Comparison Key — — — — — — — — — — 0xFFBD NVPROT FPS FPDIS 0xFFBE Unused — — — — — — — — 0xFFBF NVOPT KEYEN FNORED 0 0 0 0 SEC01 SEC00 Provided the key enable (KEYEN) bit is 1, the 8-byte comparison key can be used to temporarily disengage memory security. This key mechanism can be accessed only through user code running in secure memory. (A security key cannot be entered directly through background debug commands.) This security key can be disabled completely by programming the KEYEN bit to 0. If the security key is disabled, the only way to disengage security is by mass erasing the flash if needed (normally through the background debug interface) and verifying that flash is blank. To avoid returning to secure mode after the next reset, program the security bits (SEC01:SEC00) to the unsecured state (1:0). The ICS factory-trimmed value will be stored in 0xFFAE (bit-0) and 0xFFAF. Development tools, such as programmers can trim the ICS and the internal temperature sensor (via the ADC) and store the values in 0xFFAD–0xFFAF. 4.4 RAM The MC9S08QD4 series includes static RAM. The locations in RAM below 0x0100 can be accessed using the more efficient direct addressing mode, and any single bit in this area can be accessed with the bit manipulation instructions (BCLR, BSET, BRCLR, and BRSET). Locating the most frequently accessed program variables in this area of RAM is preferred. The RAM retains data when the MCU is in low-power wait, stop2, or stop3 mode. At power-on or after wakeup from stop1, the contents of RAM are uninitialized. RAM data is unaffected by any reset provided that the supply voltage does not drop below the minimum value for RAM retention (VRAM). MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 38 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition For compatibility with M68HC05 MCUs, the HCS08 resets the stack pointer to 0x00FF. In the MC9S08QD4 series, it is usually best to reinitialize the stack pointer to the top of the RAM so the direct page RAM can be used for frequently accessed RAM variables and bit-addressable program variables. Include the following 2-instruction sequence in your reset initialization routine (where RamLast is equated to the highest address of the RAM in the Freescale Semiconductor-provided equate file). LDHX TXS #RamLast+1 ;point one past RAM ;SP<-(H:X-1) When security is enabled, the RAM is considered a secure memory resource and is not accessible through BDM or through code executing from non-secure memory. See Section 4.6, “Security,” for a detailed description of the security feature. 4.5 Flash The flash memory is intended primarily for program storage. In-circuit programming allows the operating program to be loaded into the flash memory after final assembly of the application product. It is possible to program the entire array through the single-wire background debug interface. Because no special voltages are needed for flash erase and programming operations, in-application programming is also possible through other software-controlled communication paths. For a more detailed discussion of in-circuit and in-application programming, refer to the HCS08 Family Reference Manual, Volume I, Freescale Semiconductor document order number HCS08RMv1. 4.5.1 Features Features of the flash memory include: • Flash size — MC9S08QD4/S9S08QD4: 4096 bytes (8 pages of 512 bytes each) — MC9S08QD2/S9S08QD2: 2048 bytes (4 pages of 512 bytes each) • Single power supply program and erase • Command interface for fast program and erase operation • Up to 100,000 program/erase cycles at typical voltage and temperature • Flexible block protection • Security feature for flash and RAM • Auto power-down for low-frequency read accesses 4.5.2 Program and Erase Times Before any program or erase command can be accepted, the flash clock divider register (FCDIV) must be written to set the internal clock for the flash module to a frequency (fFCLK) between 150 kHz and 200 kHz (see Section 4.7.1, “Flash Clock Divider Register (FCDIV).”) This register can be written only once, so normally this write is performed during reset initialization. FCDIV cannot be written if the access error flag, FACCERR in FSTAT, is set. The user must ensure that FACCERR is not set before writing to the FCDIV register. One period of the resulting clock (1/fFCLK) is used by the command processor to time MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 39 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition program and erase pulses. An integer number of these timing pulses is used by the command processor to complete a program or erase command. Table 4-5 shows program and erase times. The bus clock frequency and FCDIV determine the frequency of FCLK (fFCLK). The time for one cycle of FCLK is tFCLK = 1/fFCLK. The times are shown as a number of cycles of FCLK and as an absolute time for the case where tFCLK = 5 μs. Program and erase times shown include overhead for the command state machine and enabling and disabling of program and erase voltages. Table 4-5. Program and Erase Times 1 4.5.3 Parameter Cycles of FCLK Time if FCLK = 200 kHz Byte program 9 45 μs Byte program (burst) 4 20 μs1 Page erase 4000 20 ms Mass erase 20,000 100 ms Excluding start/end overhead Program and Erase Command Execution The steps for executing any of the commands are listed below. The FCDIV register must be initialized and any error flags cleared before beginning command execution. The command execution steps are: 1. Write a data value to an address in the flash array. The address and data information from this write is latched into the flash interface. This write is a required first step in any command sequence. For erase and blank check commands, the value of the data is not important. For page erase commands, the address can be any address in the 512-byte page of flash to be erased. For mass erase and blank check commands, the address can be any address in the flash memory. Whole pages of 512 bytes are the smallest block of flash that can be erased. NOTE • A mass or page erase of the last page in flash will erase the factory programmed internal reference clock trim value. • Do not program any byte in the flash more than once after a successful erase operation. Reprogramming bits in a byte which is already programmed is not allowed without first erasing the page in which the byte resides or mass erasing the entire flash memory. Programming without first erasing may disturb data stored in the flash. 2. Write the command code for the desired command to FCMD. The five valid commands are blank check (0x05), byte program (0x20), burst program (0x25), page erase (0x40), and mass erase (0x41). The command code is latched into the command buffer. 3. Write a 1 to the FCBEF bit in FSTAT to clear FCBEF and launch the command (including its address and data information). A partial command sequence can be aborted manually by writing a 0 to FCBEF any time after the write to the memory array and before writing the 1 that clears FCBEF and launches the complete command. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 40 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition Aborting a command in this way sets the FACCERR access error flag which must be cleared before starting a new command. A strictly monitored procedure must be obeyed or the command will not be accepted. This minimizes the possibility of any unintended changes to the flash memory contents. The command complete flag (FCCF) indicates when a command is complete. The command sequence must be completed by clearing FCBEF to launch the command. Figure 4-2 is a flowchart for executing all of the commands except for burst programming. The FCDIV register must be initialized following any reset before using any flash commands. START FACCERR ? 0 CLEAR ERROR (1) Required only once WRITE TO FCDIV(1) after reset. WRITE TO FLASH TO BUFFER ADDRESS AND DATA WRITE COMMAND TO FCMD WRITE 1 TO FCBEF TO LAUNCH COMMAND AND CLEAR FCBEF (2) FPVIO OR FACCERR ? (2) Wait at least four bus cycles before checking FCBEF or FCCF. YES ERROR EXIT NO 0 FCCF ? 1 DONE Figure 4-2. Flash Program and Erase Flowchart 4.5.4 Burst Program Execution The burst program command is used to program sequential bytes of data in less time than would be required using the standard program command. This is possible because the high voltage to the flash array does not need to be disabled between program operations. Ordinarily, when a program or erase command is issued, an internal charge pump associated with the flash memory must be enabled to supply high voltage to the array. Upon completion of the command, the charge pump is turned off. When a burst MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 41 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition program command is issued, the charge pump is enabled and then remains enabled after completion of the burst program operation if these two conditions are met: • The next burst program command has been queued before the current program operation has completed. • The next sequential address selects a byte on the same physical row as the current byte being programmed. A row of flash memory consists of 64 bytes. A byte within a row is selected by addresses A5 through A0. A new row begins when addresses A5 through A0 are all 0s. The first byte of a series of sequential bytes being programmed in burst mode will take the same amount of time to program as a byte programmed in standard mode. Subsequent bytes will program in the burst program time provided that the conditions above are met. In the case the next sequential address is the beginning of a new row, the program time for that byte will be the standard time instead of the burst time. This is because the high voltage to the array must be disabled and then enabled again. If a new burst command has not been queued before the current command completes, then the charge pump will be disabled and high voltage removed from the array. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 42 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition START 0 FACCERR ? 1 CLEAR ERROR WRITE TO FCDIV(1) FCBEF ? (1) Required only once after reset. 0 1 WRITE TO FLASH TO BUFFER ADDRESS AND DATA WRITE COMMAND TO FCMD WRITE 1 TO FCBEF TO LAUNCH COMMAND AND CLEAR FCBEF (2) FPVIO OR FACCERR ? (2) Wait at least four bus cycles before checking FCBEF or FCCF. YES ERROR EXIT NO YES NEW BURST COMMAND ? NO 0 FCCF ? 1 DONE Figure 4-3. Flash Burst Program Flowchart 4.5.5 Access Errors An access error occurs whenever the command execution protocol is violated. Any of the following specific actions will cause the access error flag (FACCERR) in FSTAT to be set. FACCERR must be cleared by writing a 1 to FACCERR in FSTAT before any command can be processed. • Writing to a flash address before the internal flash clock frequency has been set by writing to the FCDIV register • Writing to a flash address while FCBEF is not set (A new command cannot be started until the command buffer is empty.) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 43 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition • • • • • • • • 4.5.6 Writing a second time to a flash address before launching the previous command (There is only one write to flash for every command.) Writing a second time to FCMD before launching the previous command (There is only one write to FCMD for every command.) Writing to any flash control register other than FCMD after writing to a flash address Writing any command code other than the five allowed codes (0x05, 0x20, 0x25, 0x40, or 0x41) to FCMD Writing any flash control register other than to write to FSTAT (to clear FCBEF and launch the command) after writing the command to FCMD. The MCU enters stop mode while a program or erase command is in progress (The command is aborted.) Writing the byte program, burst program, or page erase command code (0x20, 0x25, or 0x40) with a background debug command while the MCU is secured (The background debug controller can do blank check and mass erase commands only when the MCU is secure.) Writing 0 to FCBEF to cancel a partial command Flash Block Protection The block protection feature prevents the protected region of flash from program or erase changes. Block protection is controlled through the flash protection register (FPROT). When enabled, block protection begins at any 512 byte boundary below the last address of flash, 0xFFFF. (see Section 4.7.4, “Flash Protection Register (FPROT and NVPROT).”) After exit from reset, FPROT is loaded with the contents of the NVPROT location which is in the nonvolatile register block of the flash memory. FPROT cannot be changed directly from application software so a runaway program cannot alter the block protection settings. Because NVPROT is within the last 512 bytes of flash, if any amount of memory is protected, NVPROT is itself protected and cannot be altered (intentionally or unintentionally) by the application software. FPROT can be written through background debug commands, which allows a way to erase and reprogram a protected flash memory. The block protection mechanism is illustrated in Figure 4-4. The FPS bits are used as the upper bits of the last address of unprotected memory. This address is formed by concatenating FPS7:FPS1 with logic 1 bits as shown. For example, in order to protect the last 8192 bytes of memory (addresses 0xE000 through 0xFFFF), the FPS bits must be set to 1101 111, which results in the value 0xDFFF as the last address of unprotected memory. In addition to programming the FPS bits to the appropriate value, FPDIS (bit 0 of NVPROT) must be programmed to logic 0 to enable block protection. Therefore the value 0xDE must be programmed into NVPROT to protect addresses 0xE000 through 0xFFFF. FPS7 FPS6 FPS5 A15 A14 A13 FPS4 FPS3 FPS2 FPS1 A12 A11 A10 A9 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 A8 A7 A6 A5 A4 A3 A2 A1 A0 Figure 4-4. Block Protection Mechanism MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 44 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition One use for block protection is to block protect an area of flash memory for a bootloader program. This bootloader program then can be used to erase the rest of the flash memory and reprogram it. Because the bootloader is protected, it remains intact even if MCU power is lost in the middle of an erase and reprogram operation. 4.5.7 Vector Redirection Whenever any block protection is enabled, the reset and interrupt vectors will be protected. Vector redirection allows users to modify interrupt vector information without unprotecting bootloader and reset vector space. Vector redirection is enabled by programming the FNORED bit in the NVOPT register located at address 0xFFBF to 0. For redirection to occur, at least some portion but not all of the flash memory must be block protected by programming the NVPROT register located at address 0xFFBD. All of the interrupt vectors (memory locations 0xFFC0–0xFFFD) are redirected, though the reset vector (0xFFFE:FFFF) is not. For example, if 512 bytes of flash are protected, the protected address region is from 0xFE00 through 0xFFFF. The interrupt vectors (0xFFC0–0xFFFD) are redirected to the locations 0xFDC0–0xFDFD. For example, vector redirection is enabled and an interrupt occurs, the values in the locations 0xFDE0:FDE1 are used for the vector instead of the values in the locations 0xFFE0:FFE1. This allows the user to reprogram the unprotected portion of the flash with new program code including new interrupt vector values while leaving the protected area, which includes the default vector locations, unchanged. 4.6 Security The MC9S08QD4 series includes circuitry to prevent unauthorized access to the contents of flash and RAM memory. When security is engaged, flash and RAM are considered secure resources. Direct-page registers, high-page registers, and the background debug controller are considered unsecured resources. Programs executing within secure memory have normal access to any MCU memory locations and resources. Attempts to access a secure memory location with a program executing from an unsecured memory space or through the background debug interface are blocked (writes are ignored and reads return all 0s). Security is engaged or disengaged based on the state of two register bits (SEC01:SEC00) in the FOPT register. During reset, the contents of the nonvolatile location NVOPT are copied from flash into the working FOPT register in high-page register space. A user engages security by programming the NVOPT location, which can be performed at the same time the flash memory is programmed. The 1:0 state disengages security and the other three combinations engage security. Notice the erased state (1:1) makes the MCU secure. During development, whenever the flash is erased, it is good practice to immediately program the SEC00 bit to 0 in NVOPT so SEC01:SEC00 = 1:0. This would allow the MCU to remain unsecured after a subsequent reset. The on-chip debug module cannot be enabled while the MCU is secure. The separate background debug controller can be used for background memory access commands, but the MCU cannot enter active background mode except by holding BKGD/MS low at the rising edge of reset. A user can choose to allow or disallow a security unlocking mechanism through an 8-byte backdoor security key. If the nonvolatile KEYEN bit in NVOPT/FOPT is 0, the backdoor key is disabled and there MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 45 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition is no way to disengage security without completely erasing all flash locations. If KEYEN is 1, a secure user program can temporarily disengage security by: 1. Writing 1 to KEYACC in the FCNFG register. This makes the flash module interpret writes to the backdoor comparison key locations (NVBACKKEY through NVBACKKEY+7) as values to be compared against the key rather than as the first step in a flash program or erase command. 2. Writing the user-entered key values to the NVBACKKEY through NVBACKKEY+7 locations. These writes must be performed in order starting with the value for NVBACKKEY and ending with NVBACKKEY+7. STHX must not be used for these writes because these writes cannot be performed on adjacent bus cycles. User software normally would get the key codes from outside the MCU system through a communication interface such as a serial I/O. 3. Writing 0 to KEYACC in the FCNFG register. If the 8-byte key that was written matches the key stored in the flash locations, SEC01:SEC00 are automatically changed to 1:0 and security will be disengaged until the next reset. The security key can be written only from secure memory (either RAM or flash), so it cannot be entered through background commands without the cooperation of a secure user program. The backdoor comparison key (NVBACKKEY through NVBACKKEY+7) is located in flash memory locations in the nonvolatile register space so users can program these locations exactly as they would program any other flash memory location. The nonvolatile registers are in the same 512-byte block of flash as the reset and interrupt vectors, so block protecting that space also block protects the backdoor comparison key. Block protects cannot be changed from user application programs, so if the vector space is block protected, the backdoor security key mechanism cannot permanently change the block protect, security settings, or the backdoor key. Security can always be disengaged through the background debug interface by taking these steps: 1. Disable any block protections by writing FPROT. FPROT can be written only with background debug commands, not from application software. 2. Mass erase flash if necessary. 3. Blank check flash. Provided flash is completely erased, security is disengaged until the next reset. To avoid returning to secure mode after the next reset, program NVOPT so SEC01:SEC00 = 1:0. 4.7 Flash Registers and Control Bits The flash module has nine 8-bit registers in the high-page register space, two locations (NVOPT, NVPROT) in the nonvolatile register space in flash memory are copied into corresponding high-page control registers (FOPT, FPROT) at reset. There is also an 8-byte comparison key in flash memory. Refer to Table 4-3 and Table 4-4 for the absolute address assignments for all flash registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A Freescale Semiconductor-provided equate or header file normally is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses. 4.7.1 Flash Clock Divider Register (FCDIV) Before any erase or programming operations are possible, write to this register to set the frequency of the clock for the nonvolatile memory system within acceptable limits. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 46 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 7 R 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 DIVLD PRDIV8 DIV W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 4-5. Flash Clock Divider Register (FCDIV) Table 4-6. FCDIV Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 DIVLD Divisor Loaded Status Flag — When set, this read-only status flag indicates that the FCDIV register has been written since reset. Reset clears this bit and the first write to this register causes this bit to become set regardless of the data written. 0 FCDIV has not been written since reset; erase and program operations disabled for flash. 1 FCDIV has been written since reset; erase and program operations enabled for flash. 6 PRDIV8 5:0 DIV Prescale (Divide) Flash Clock by 8 0 Clock input to the flash clock divider is the bus rate clock. 1 Clock input to the flash clock divider is the bus rate clock divided by 8. Divisor for Flash Clock Divider — The flash clock divider divides the bus rate clock (or the bus rate clock divided by 8 if PRDIV8 = 1) by the value in the 6-bit DIV field plus one. The resulting frequency of the internal flash clock must fall within the range of 200 kHz to 150 kHz for proper flash operations. Program/Erase timing pulses are one cycle of this internal flash clock which corresponds to a range of 5 μs to 6.7 μs. The automated programming logic uses an integer number of these pulses to complete an erase or program operation. See Equation 4-1 and Equation 4-2. if PRDIV8 = 0 – fFCLK = fBus ÷ (DIV + 1) Eqn. 4-1 if PRDIV8 = 1 – fFCLK = fBus ÷ (8 × (DIV + 1)) Eqn. 4-2 Table 4-7 shows the appropriate values for PRDIV8 and DIV for selected bus frequencies. Table 4-7. Flash Clock Divider Settings fBus PRDIV8 (Binary) DIV (Decimal) fFCLK Program/Erase Timing Pulse (5 μs Min, 6.7 μs Max) 8 MHz 0 39 200 kHz 5 μs 4 MHz 0 19 200 kHz 5 μs 2 MHz 0 9 200 kHz 5 μs 1 MHz 0 4 200 kHz 5 μs 200 kHz 0 0 200 kHz 5 μs 150 kHz 0 0 150 kHz 6.7 μs MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 47 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 4.7.2 Flash Options Register (FOPT and NVOPT) During reset, the contents of the nonvolatile location NVOPT are copied from flash into FOPT. To change the value in this register, erase and reprogram the NVOPT location in flash memory as usual and then issue a new MCU reset. R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 KEYEN FNORED 0 0 0 0 SEC01 SEC00 W Reset This register is loaded from nonvolatile location NVOPT during reset. = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 4-6. Flash Options Register (FOPT) Table 4-8. FOPT Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 KEYEN Backdoor Key Mechanism Enable — When this bit is 0, the backdoor key mechanism cannot be used to disengage security. The backdoor key mechanism is accessible only from user (secured) firmware. BDM commands cannot be used to write key comparison values that would unlock the backdoor key. For more detailed information about the backdoor key mechanism, refer to Section 4.6, “Security.” 0 No backdoor key access allowed. 1 If user firmware writes an 8-byte value that matches the nonvolatile backdoor key (NVBACKKEY through NVBACKKEY+7 in that order), security is temporarily disengaged until the next MCU reset. 6 FNORED Vector Redirection Disable — When this bit is 1, then vector redirection is disabled. 0 Vector redirection enabled. 1 Vector redirection disabled. 1:0 SEC0[1:0] Security State Code — This 2-bit field determines the security state of the MCU as shown in Table 4-9. When the MCU is secure, the contents of RAM and flash memory cannot be accessed by instructions from any unsecured source including the background debug interface. SEC01:SEC00 changes to 1:0 after successful backdoor key entry or a successful blank check of flash. For more detailed information about security, refer to Section 4.6, “Security.” Table 4-9. Security States1 1 SEC01:SEC00 Description 0:0 secure 0:1 secure 1:0 unsecured 1:1 secure SEC01:SEC00 changes to 1:0 after successful backdoor key entry or a successful blank check of flash. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 48 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 4.7.3 R Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG) 7 6 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 KEYACC W Reset 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 4-7. Flash Configuration Register (FCNFG) Table 4-10. FCNFG Register Field Descriptions Field Description 5 KEYACC Enable Writing of Access Key — This bit enables writing of the backdoor comparison key. For more detailed information about the backdoor key mechanism, refer to Section 4.6, “Security.” 0 Writes to 0xFFB0–0xFFB7 are interpreted as the start of a flash programming or erase command. 1 Writes to NVBACKKEY (0xFFB0–0xFFB7) are interpreted as comparison key writes. 4.7.4 Flash Protection Register (FPROT and NVPROT) During reset, the contents of the nonvolatile location NVPROT is copied from flash into FPROT. This register can be read at any time, but user program writes have no meaning or effect. 7 R 6 5 4 3 2 1 FPS(1) 0 FPDIS(1) W Reset 1 This register is loaded from nonvolatile location NVPROT during reset. Background commands can be used to change the contents of these bits in FPROT. Figure 4-8. Flash Protection Register (FPROT) Table 4-11. FPROT Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7:1 FPS Flash Protect Select Bits — When FPDIS = 0, this 7-bit field determines the ending address of unprotected flash locations at the high address end of the flash. Protected flash locations cannot be erased or programmed. 0 FPDIS Flash Protection Disable 0 Flash block specified by FPS7:FPS1 is block protected (program and erase not allowed). 1 No flash block is protected. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 49 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 4.7.5 Flash Status Register (FSTAT) 7 R 6 5 4 FPVIOL FACCERR 0 0 FCCF FCBEF 3 2 1 0 0 FBLANK 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset 1 1 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 4-9. Flash Status Register (FSTAT) Table 4-12. FSTAT Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 FCBEF Flash Command Buffer Empty Flag — The FCBEF bit is used to launch commands. It also indicates that the command buffer is empty so that a new command sequence can be executed when performing burst programming. The FCBEF bit is cleared by writing a 1 to it or when a burst program command is transferred to the array for programming. Only burst program commands can be buffered. 0 Command buffer is full (not ready for additional commands). 1 A new burst program command can be written to the command buffer. 6 FCCF Flash Command Complete Flag — FCCF is set automatically when the command buffer is empty and no command is being processed. FCCF is cleared automatically when a new command is started (by writing 1 to FCBEF to register a command). Writing to FCCF has no meaning or effect. 0 Command in progress 1 All commands complete 5 FPVIOL Protection Violation Flag — FPVIOL is set automatically when FCBEF is cleared to register a command that attempts to erase or program a location in a protected block (the erroneous command is ignored). FPVIOL is cleared by writing a 1 to FPVIOL. 0 No protection violation. 1 An attempt was made to erase or program a protected location. 4 FACCERR Access Error Flag — FACCERR is set automatically when the proper command sequence is not obeyed exactly (the erroneous command is ignored), if a program or erase operation is attempted before the FCDIV register has been initialized, or if the MCU enters stop while a command was in progress. For a more detailed discussion of the exact actions that are considered access errors, see Section 4.5.5, “Access Errors.” FACCERR is cleared by writing a 1 to FACCERR. Writing a 0 to FACCERR has no meaning or effect. 0 No access error. 1 An access error has occurred. 2 FBLANK Flash Verified as All Blank (erased) Flag — FBLANK is set automatically at the conclusion of a blank check command if the entire flash array was verified to be erased. FBLANK is cleared by clearing FCBEF to write a new valid command. Writing to FBLANK has no meaning or effect. 0 After a blank check command is completed and FCCF = 1, FBLANK = 0 indicates the flash array is not completely erased. 1 After a blank check command is completed and FCCF = 1, FBLANK = 1 indicates the flash array is completely erased (all 0xFF). MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 50 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition 4.7.6 Flash Command Register (FCMD) Only five command codes are recognized in normal user modes as shown in Table 4-13. Refer to Section 4.5.3, “Program and Erase Command Execution,” for a detailed discussion of flash programming and erase operations. R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset FCMD 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 4-10. Flash Command Register (FCMD) Table 4-13. Flash Commands Command FCMD Equate File Label Blank check 0x05 mBlank Byte program 0x20 mByteProg Byte program — burst mode 0x25 mBurstProg Page erase (512 bytes/page) 0x40 mPageErase Mass erase (all flash) 0x41 mMassErase All other command codes are illegal and generate an access error. It is not necessary to perform a blank check command after a mass erase operation. Only blank check is required as part of the security unlocking mechanism. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 51 Chapter 4 Memory Map and Register Definition MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 52 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.1 Introduction This chapter discusses basic reset and interrupt mechanisms and the various sources of reset and interrupts in the MC9S08QD4 series. Some interrupt sources from peripheral modules are discussed in greater detail within other sections of this data sheet. This section gathers basic information about all reset and interrupt sources in one place for easy reference. A few reset and interrupt sources, including the computer operating properly (COP) watchdog and real-time interrupt (RTI), are not part of on-chip peripheral systems with their own chapters but are part of the system control logic. 5.2 Features Reset and interrupt features include: • Multiple sources of reset for flexible system configuration and reliable operation • Reset status register (SRS) to indicate source of most recent reset • Separate interrupt vectors for each module (reduces polling overhead) (see Table 5-2) 5.3 MCU Reset Resetting the MCU provides a way to start processing from a known set of initial conditions. During reset, most control and status registers are forced to initial values and the program counter is loaded from the reset vector (0xFFFE:0xFFFF). On-chip peripheral modules are disabled and I/O pins are initially configured as general-purpose high-impedance inputs with pullup devices disabled. The I bit in the condition code register (CCR) is set to block maskable interrupts so the user program has a chance to initialize the stack pointer (SP) and system control settings. SP is forced to 0x00FF at reset. The MC9S08QD4 series has the following sources for reset: • External pin reset (PIN) - enabled using RSTPE in SOPT1 • Power-on reset (POR) • Low-voltage detect (LVD) • Computer operating properly (COP) timer • Illegal opcode detect (ILOP) • Illegal address detect (ILAD) • Background debug forced reset Each of these sources, with the exception of the background debug forced reset, has an associated bit in the system reset status register. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 53 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.4 Computer Operating Properly (COP) Watchdog The COP watchdog is intended to force a system reset when the application software fails to execute as expected. To prevent a system reset from the COP timer (when it is enabled), application software must reset the COP counter periodically. If the application program gets lost and fails to reset the COP counter before it times out, a system reset is generated to force the system back to a known starting point. After any reset, the COPE becomes set in SOPT1 enabling the COP watchdog (see Section 5.8.5, “System Options Register 2 (SOPT2),” for additional information). If the COP watchdog is not used in an application, it can be disabled by clearing COPE. The COP counter is reset by writing any value to the address of SRS. This write does not affect the data in the read-only SRS. Instead, the act of writing to this address is decoded and sends a reset signal to the COP counter. The COPCLKS bit in SOPT2 (see Section 5.8.5, “System Options Register 2 (SOPT2),” for additional information) selects the clock source used for the COP timer. The clock source options are either the bus clock or an internal 32 kHz clock source. With each clock source, there is an associated short and long time-out controlled by COPT in SOPT1. Table 5-1 summaries the control functions of the COPCLKS and COPT bits. The COP watchdog defaults to operation from the 32 kHz clock source and the associated long time-out (28 cycles). Table 5-1. COP Configuration Options Control Bits 1 Clock Source COP Overflow Count 0 ~32 kHz 210 cycles (32 ms)1 0 1 ~32 kHz 213 cycles (256 ms)1 1 0 Bus 213 cycles 1 1 Bus 218 cycles COPCLKS COPT 0 Values are shown in this column based on tRTI = 1 ms. See tRTI in the Section A.8.1, “Control Timing,” for the tolerance of this value. Even if the application will use the reset default settings of COPE, COPCLKS and COPT, the user must write to the write-once SOPT1 and SOPT2 registers during reset initialization to lock in the settings. That way, they cannot be changed accidentally if the application program gets lost. The initial writes to SOPT1 and SOPT2 will reset the COP counter. The write to SRS that services (clears) the COP counter must not be placed in an interrupt service routine (ISR) because the ISR could continue to be executed periodically even if the main application program fails. In Background debug mode, the COP counter will not increment. When the bus clock source is selected, the COP counter does not increment while the system is in stop mode. The COP counter resumes once the MCU exits stop mode. When the 32 kHz clock source is selected, the COP counter is re-initialized to zero upon entry to stop mode. The COP counter begins from zero once the MCU exits stop mode. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 54 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.5 Interrupts Interrupts provide a way to save the current CPU status and registers, execute an interrupt service routine (ISR), and then restore the CPU status so processing resumes where it was before the interrupt. Other than the software interrupt (SWI), which is a program instruction, interrupts are caused by hardware events such as an edge on the IRQ pin or a timer-overflow event. The debug module can also generate an SWI under certain circumstances. If an event occurs in an enabled interrupt source, an associated read-only status flag will become set. The CPU will not respond until and unless the local interrupt enable is a 1 to enable the interrupt. The I bit in the CCR is 0 to allow interrupts. The global interrupt mask (I bit) in the CCR is initially set after reset which masks (prevents) all maskable interrupt sources. The user program initializes the stack pointer and performs other system setup before clearing the I bit to allow the CPU to respond to interrupts. When the CPU receives a qualified interrupt request, it completes the current instruction before responding to the interrupt. The interrupt sequence obeys the same cycle-by-cycle sequence as the SWI instruction and consists of: • • • • Saving the CPU registers on the stack Setting the I bit in the CCR to mask further interrupts Fetching the interrupt vector for the highest-priority interrupt that is currently pending Filling the instruction queue with the first three bytes of program information starting from the address fetched from the interrupt vector locations While the CPU is responding to the interrupt, the I bit is automatically set to avoid the possibility of another interrupt interrupting the ISR itself (this is called nesting of interrupts). Normally, the I bit is restored to 0 when the CCR is restored from the value stacked on entry to the ISR. In rare cases, the I bit can be cleared inside an ISR (after clearing the status flag that generated the interrupt) so that other interrupts can be serviced without waiting for the first service routine to finish. This practice is not recommended for anyone other than the most experienced programmers because it can lead to subtle program errors that are difficult to debug. The interrupt service routine ends with a return-from-interrupt (RTI) instruction which restores the CCR, A, X, and PC registers to their pre-interrupt values by reading the previously saved information off the stack. NOTE For compatibility with M68HC08 devices, the H register is not automatically saved and restored. It is good programming practice to push H onto the stack at the start of the interrupt service routine (ISR) and restore it immediately before the RTI that is used to return from the ISR. When two or more interrupts are pending when the I bit is cleared, the highest priority source is serviced first (see Table 5-2). MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 55 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.5.1 Interrupt Stack Frame Figure 5-1 shows the contents and organization of a stack frame. Before the interrupt, the stack pointer (SP) points at the next available byte location on the stack. The current values of CPU registers are stored on the stack starting with the low-order byte of the program counter (PCL) and ending with the CCR. After stacking, the SP points at the next available location on the stack which is the address that is one less than the address where the CCR was saved. The PC value that is stacked is the address of the instruction in the main program that would have executed next if the interrupt had not occurred. UNSTACKING ORDER TOWARD LOWER ADDRESSES 7 0 5 1 4 2 3 3 2 4 PROGRAM COUNTER HIGH 1 5 PROGRAM COUNTER LOW CONDITION CODE REGISTER SP AFTER INTERRUPT STACKING ACCUMULATOR INDEX REGISTER (LOW BYTE X)* STACKING ORDER SP BEFORE THE INTERRUPT TOWARD HIGHER ADDRESSES * High byte (H) of index register is not automatically stacked. Figure 5-1. Interrupt Stack Frame When an RTI instruction is executed, these values are recovered from the stack in reverse order. As part of the RTI sequence, the CPU fills the instruction pipeline by reading three bytes of program information, starting from the PC address recovered from the stack. The status flag causing the interrupt must be acknowledged (cleared) before returning from the ISR. Typically, the flag is cleared at the beginning of the ISR so that if another interrupt is generated by this same source, it will be registered so it can be serviced after completion of the current ISR. 5.5.2 External Interrupt Request (IRQ) Pin External interrupts are managed by the IRQ status and control register, IRQSC. When the IRQ function is enabled, synchronous logic monitors the pin for edge-only or edge-and-level events. When the MCU is in stop mode and system clocks are shut down, a separate asynchronous path is used so the IRQ (if enabled) can wake the MCU. 5.5.2.1 Pin Configuration Options The IRQ pin enable (IRQPE) control bit in IRQSC must be 1 in order for the IRQ pin to act as the interrupt request (IRQ) input. As an IRQ input, the user can choose the polarity of edges or levels detected (IRQEDG), whether the pin detects edges-only or edges and levels (IRQMOD), and whether an event causes an interrupt or only sets the IRQF flag which can be polled by software. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 56 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control The IRQ pin when enabled defaults to use an internal pull device (IRQPDD = 0), the device is a pullup or pulldown depending on the polarity to detect. If the user desires to use an external pullup or pulldown, the IRQPDD can be written to a 1 to turn off the internal device. BIH and BIL instructions may be used to detect the level on the IRQ pin when the pin is configured to act as the IRQ input. NOTE This pin does not contain a clamp diode to VDD and must not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on the internally pulled up IRQ pin may be as low as VDD – 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled all the way to VDD. 5.5.2.2 Edge and Level Sensitivity The IRQMOD control bit reconfigures the detection logic so it detects edge events and pin levels. In this edge detection mode, the IRQF status flag becomes set when an edge is detected (when the IRQ pin changes from the deasserted to the asserted level), but the flag is continuously set (and cannot be cleared) as long as the IRQ pin remains at the asserted level. 5.5.3 Interrupt Vectors, Sources, and Local Masks Table 5-2 provides a summary of all interrupt sources. Higher-priority sources are located toward the bottom of the table. The high-order byte of the address for the interrupt service routine is located at the first address in the vector address column, and the low-order byte of the address for the interrupt service routine is located at the next higher address. When an interrupt condition occurs, an associated flag bit becomes set. If the associated local interrupt enable is 1, an interrupt request is sent to the CPU. Within the CPU, if the global interrupt mask (I bit in the CCR) is 0, the CPU will finish the current instruction; stack the PCL, PCH, X, A, and CCR CPU registers; set the I bit; and then fetch the interrupt vector for the highest priority pending interrupt. Processing then continues in the interrupt service routine. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 57 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control Table 5-2. Vector Summary Vector Priority Vector Number Address (High:Low) Lower 31 through 24 0xFFC0:FFC1 through 0xFFCE:FFCF 23 0xFFD0:FFD1 Vrti 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 0xFFD2:FFD3 0xFFD4:FFD5 0xFFD6:FFD7 0xFFD8:FFD9 0xFFDA:FFDB 0xFFDC:FFDD 0xFFDE:FFDF 0xFFE0:FFE1 0xFFE2:FFE3 0xFFE4:FFE5 0xFFE6:FFE7 0xFFE8:FFE9 0xFFEA:FFEB 0xFFEC:FFED 0xFFEE:FFEF 0xFFF0:FFF1 0xFFF2:FFF3 0xFFF4:FFF5 0xFFF6:FFF7 0xFFF8:FFF9 — — — Vadc1 Vkeyboard1 — — — — — — — Vtpm2ovf — Vtpm2ch0 Vtpm1ovf Vtpm1ch1 Vtpm1ch0 — Virq 2 0xFFFA:FFFB Vlvd 1 0xFFFC:FFFD Vswi 0 Vector Name 0xFFFE:FFFF Module Enable Description Unused Vector Space (available for user program) Vreset System control — — — ADC1 KBI1 — — — — — — — TPM2 — TPM2 TPM1 TPM1 TPM1 — IRQ System control CPU System control Higher 5.6 Source RTIF RTIE Real-time interrupt — — — COCO KBF — — — — — — — TOF — CH0F TOF CH1F CH0F — IRRQF — — — AIEN KBIE — — — — — — — TOIE — CH0IE TOIE CH1IE CH0IE — IRQIE — — — ADC1 Keyboard pins — — — — — — — TPM2 overflow — TPM2 channel 0 TPM1 overflow TPM1 channel 1 TPM1 channel 0 — IRQ pin LVDF LVDIE Low voltage detect — Software interrupt COPE LVDRE RSTPE — — — Watchdog timer Low-voltage detect External pin Illegal opcode Illegal address power-on-reset SWI Instruction COP LVD RESET pin Illegal opcode Illegal address POR Low-Voltage Detect (LVD) System The MC9S08QD4 series includes a system to protect against low voltage conditions in order to protect memory contents and control MCU system states during supply voltage variations. The system is comprised of a power-on reset (POR) circuit and an LVD circuit with a user selectable trip voltage, either high (VLVDH) or low (VLVDL). The LVD circuit is enabled when LVDE in SPMSC1 is high and the trip voltage is selected by LVDV in SPMSC3. The LVD is disabled upon entering any of the stop modes unless LVDSE is set in SPMSC1. If LVDSE and LVDE are both set, then the MCU cannot enter stop1 or stop2, and the current consumption in stop3 with the LVD enabled will be greater. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 58 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.6.1 Power-On Reset Operation When power is initially applied to the MCU, or when the supply voltage drops below the VPOR level, the POR circuit will cause a reset condition. As the supply voltage rises, the LVD circuit will hold the MCU in reset until the supply has risen above the VLVDL level. Both the POR bit and the LVD bit in SRS are set following a POR. 5.6.2 LVD Reset Operation The LVD can be configured to generate a reset upon detection of a low voltage condition by setting LVDRE to 1. After an LVD reset has occurred, the LVD system will hold the MCU in reset until the supply voltage has risen above the level determined by LVDV. The LVD bit in the SRS register is set following either an LVD reset or POR. 5.6.3 LVD Interrupt Operation When a low voltage condition is detected and the LVD circuit is configured using SPMSC1 for interrupt operation (LVDE set, LVDIE set, and LVDRE clear), then LVDF in SPMSC1 will be set and an LVD interrupt request will occur. 5.6.4 Low-Voltage Warning (LVW) The LVD system has a low voltage warning flag to indicate to the user that the supply voltage is approaching, but is above, the LVD voltage. The LVW does not have an interrupt associated with it. There are two user selectable trip voltages for the LVW, one high (VLVWH) and one low (VLVWL). The trip voltage is selected by LVWV in SPMSC3. 5.7 Real-Time Interrupt (RTI) The real-time interrupt function can be used to generate periodic interrupts. The RTI can accept two sources of clocks, the 1 kHz internal clock or an 32 kHz ICS clock if available. The RTICLKS bit in SRTISC is used to select the RTI clock source. Both clock source can be used when the MCU is in run, wait or stop3 mode. When using the 32 kHz ICS clock in stop3, it must be enabled in stop (EREFSTEN = 1) and configured for low frequency operation (RANGE = 0). Only the internal 1 kHz clock source can be selected to wake the MCU from stop1 or stop2 modes. The SRTISC register includes a read-only status flag, a write-only acknowledge bit, and a 3-bit control value (RTIS) used to select one of seven wakeup periods. The RTI has a local interrupt enable, RTIE, to allow masking of the real-time interrupt. The RTI can be disabled by writing each bit of RTIS to zeroes, and no interrupts will be generated. See Section 5.8.7, “System Real-Time Interrupt Status and Control Register (SRTISC),” for detailed information about this register. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 59 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.8 Reset, Interrupt, and System Control Registers and Control Bits One 8-bit register in the direct page register space and eight 8-bit registers in the high-page register space are related to reset and interrupt systems. Refer to the direct-page register summary in Chapter 3, “Modes of Operation,” for the absolute address assignments for all registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses. Some control bits in the SOPT1, SOPT2 and SPMSC2 registers are related to modes of operation. Although brief descriptions of these bits are provided here, the related functions are discussed in greater detail in Chapter 3, “Modes of Operation.” 5.8.1 Interrupt Pin Request Status and Control Register (IRQSC) This direct page register includes status and control bits which are used to configure the IRQ function, report status, and acknowledge IRQ events. 7 R 6 5 4 IRQPDD IRQEDG IRQPE 0 3 2 IRQF 0 W Reset 1 0 IRQIE IRQMOD 0 0 IRQACK 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 5-2. Interrupt Request Status and Control Register (IRQSC) Table 5-3. IRQSC Register Field Descriptions Field Description 6 IRQPDD Interrupt Request (IRQ) Pull Device Disable— This read/write control bit is used to disable the internal pullup/pulldown device when the IRQ pin is enabled (IRQPE = 1) allowing for an external device to be used. 0 IRQ pull device enabled if IRQPE = 1. 1 IRQ pull device disabled if IRQPE = 1. 5 IRQEDG Interrupt Request (IRQ) Edge Select — This read/write control bit is used to select the polarity of edges or levels on the IRQ pin that cause IRQF to be set. The IRQMOD control bit determines whether the IRQ pin is sensitive to both edges and levels or only edges. When the IRQ pin is enabled as the IRQ input and is configured to detect rising edges. When IRQEDG = 1 and the internal pull device is enabled, the pullup device is reconfigured as an optional pulldown device. 0 IRQ is falling edge or falling edge/low-level sensitive. 1 IRQ is rising edge or rising edge/high-level sensitive. 4 IRQPE IRQ Pin Enable — This read/write control bit enables the IRQ pin function. When this bit is set the IRQ pin can be used as an interrupt request. 0 IRQ pin function is disabled. 1 IRQ pin function is enabled. 3 IRQF IRQ Flag — This read-only status bit indicates when an interrupt request event has occurred. 0 No IRQ request. 1 IRQ event detected. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 60 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control Table 5-3. IRQSC Register Field Descriptions (continued) Field Description 2 IRQACK IRQ Acknowledge — This write-only bit is used to acknowledge interrupt request events (write 1 to clear IRQF). Writing 0 has no meaning or effect. Reads always return 0. If edge-and-level detection is selected (IRQMOD = 1), IRQF cannot be cleared while the IRQ pin remains at its asserted level. 1 IRQIE 0 IRQMOD 5.8.2 IRQ Interrupt Enable — This read/write control bit determines whether IRQ events generate an interrupt request. 0 Interrupt request when IRQF set is disabled (use polling). 1 Interrupt requested whenever IRQF = 1. IRQ Detection Mode — This read/write control bit selects either edge-only detection or edge-and-level detection. The IRQEDG control bit determines the polarity of edges and levels that are detected as interrupt request events. See Section 5.5.2.2, “Edge and Level Sensitivity,” for more details. 0 IRQ event on falling edges or rising edges only. 1 IRQ event on falling edges and low levels or on rising edges and high levels. System Reset Status Register (SRS) This high-page register includes read-only status flags to indicate the source of the most recent reset. When a debug host forces reset by writing 1 to BDFR in the SBDFR register, all of the status bits in SRS will be cleared. Writing any value to this register address clears the COP watchdog timer without affecting the contents of this register. The reset state of these bits depends on what caused the MCU to reset. R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 POR PIN COP ILOP ILAD 0 LVD 0 W 1 Writing any value to SRS address clears COP watchdog timer. POR: 1 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 LVR: 0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0 Any other reset: 0 (1) (1) (1) (1) 0 0 0 Any of these reset sources that are active at the time of reset entry will cause the corresponding bit(s) to be set; bits corresponding to sources that are not active at the time of reset entry will be cleared. Figure 5-3. System Reset Status (SRS) Table 5-4. SRS Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 POR Power-On Reset — Reset was caused by the power-on detection logic. Because the internal supply voltage was ramping up at the time, the low-voltage reset (LVR) status bit is also set to indicate that the reset occurred while the internal supply was below the LVR threshold. 0 Reset not caused by POR. 1 POR caused reset. 6 PIN External Reset Pin — Reset was caused by an active-low level on the external reset pin. 0 Reset not caused by external reset pin. 1 Reset came from external reset pin. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 61 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control Table 5-4. SRS Register Field Descriptions (continued) Field Description 5 COP Computer Operating Properly (COP) Watchdog — Reset was caused by the COP watchdog timer timing out. This reset source can be blocked by COPE = 0. 0 Reset not caused by COP timeout. 1 Reset caused by COP timeout. 4 ILOP Illegal Opcode — Reset was caused by an attempt to execute an unimplemented or illegal opcode. The STOP instruction is considered illegal if stop is disabled by STOPE = 0 in the SOPT register. The BGND instruction is considered illegal if active background mode is disabled by ENBDM = 0 in the BDCSC register. 0 Reset not caused by an illegal opcode. 1 Reset caused by an illegal opcode. 3 ILAD Illegal Address — Reset was caused by an attempt to access either data or an instruction at an unimplemented memory address. 0 Reset not caused by an illegal address 1 Reset caused by an illegal address 1 LVD Low Voltage Detect — If the LVDRE bit is set and the supply drops below the LVD trip voltage, an LVD reset will occur. This bit is also set by POR. 0 Reset not caused by LVD trip or POR. 1 Reset caused by LVD trip or POR. 5.8.3 System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) This high-page register contains a single write-only control bit. A serial background command such as WRITE_BYTE must be used to write to SBDFR. Attempts to write this register from a user program are ignored. Reads always return 0x00. R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BDFR1 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved 1 BDFR is writable only through serial background debug commands, not from user programs. Figure 5-4. System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) Table 5-5. SBDFR Register Field Descriptions Field Description 0 BDFR Background Debug Force Reset — A serial background command such as WRITE_BYTE can be used to allow an external debug host to force a target system reset. Writing 1 to this bit forces an MCU reset. This bit cannot be written from a user program. To enter user mode, PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS must be high immediately after issuing WRITE_BYTE command. To enter BDM, PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS must be low immediately after issuing WRITE_BYTE command. See A.8.1, “Control Timing,” for more information. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 62 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.8.4 System Options Register 1 (SOPT1) This high-page register is a write-once register so only the first write after reset is honored. It can be read at any time. Any subsequent attempt to write to SOPT1 (intentionally or unintentionally) is ignored to avoid accidental changes to these sensitive settings. SOPT1 must be written during the user’s reset initialization program to set the desired controls even if the desired settings are the same as the reset settings. 1 4 7 6 5 COPE COPT STOPE Reset: 1 1 0 1 0 POR: 1 1 0 1 0 R 3 2 1 0 0 0 BKGDPE RSTPE 0 1 U 0 1 0 W = Unimplemented or Reserved 1 U = unaffected Bit 4 is reserved, writes will change the value but will have no effect on this MCU. Figure 5-5. System Options Register 1 (SOPT1) Table 5-6. SOPT1 Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 COPE COP Watchdog Enable — This write-once bit selects whether the COP watchdog is enabled. 0 COP watchdog timer disabled. 1 COP watchdog timer enabled (force reset on timeout). 6 COPT COP Watchdog Timeout — This write-once bit selects the timeout period of the COP. COPT along with COPCLKS in SOPT2 defines the COP timeout period. 0 Short timeout period selected. 1 Long timeout period selected. 5 STOPE Stop Mode Enable — This write-once bit is used to enable stop mode. If stop mode is disabled and a user program attempts to execute a STOP instruction, an illegal opcode reset is forced. 0 Stop mode disabled. 1 Stop mode enabled. 1 BKGDPE Background Debug Mode Pin Enable — This write-once bit when set enables the PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS pin to function as BKGD/MS. When clear, the pin functions as one of its output only alternative functions. This pin defaults to the BKGD/MS function following any MCU reset. 0 PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS pin functions as PTA4 or TPM2CH0O. 1 PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS pin functions as BKGD/MS. 0 RSTPE RESET Pin Enable — This write-once bit when set enables the PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET pin to function as RESET. When clear, the pin functions as one of its input only alternative functions. This pin defaults to its input-only port function following an MCU POR. When RSTPE is set, an internal pullup device is enabled on RESET. 0 PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET pin functions as PTA5, IRQ or TPM2CH0I. 1 PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET pin functions as RESET. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 63 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control 5.8.5 System Options Register 2 (SOPT2) This high-page register contains bits to configure MCU-specific features on MC9S08QD4 series devices. 7 R COPCLKS1 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset: 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved 1 This bit can be written only one time after reset. Additional writes are ignored. Figure 5-6. System Options Register 2 (SOPT2) Table 5-7. SOPT2 Register Field Descriptions Field 7 COPCLKS 5.8.6 Description COP Watchdog Clock Select — This write-once bit selects the clock source of the COP watchdog. 0 Internal 32 kHz clock is source to COP. 1 Bus clock is source to COP. System Device Identification Register (SDIDH, SDIDL) These high-page read-only registers are included so host development systems can identify the HCS08 derivative and revision number. This allows the development software to recognize where specific memory blocks, registers, and control bits are located in a target MCU. R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 REV3 REV2 REV1 REV0 ID11 ID10 ID9 ID8 01 01 01 01 0 0 0 0 W Reset: = Unimplemented or Reserved 1 The revision number that is hard coded into these bits reflects the current silicon revision level. Figure 5-7. System Device Identification Register — High (SDIDH) Table 5-8. SDIDH Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7:4 REV[3:0] Revision Number — The high-order 4 bits of address SDIDH are hard coded to reflect the current mask set revision number (0–F). 3:0 ID[11:8] Part Identification Number — Each derivative in the HCS08 family has a unique identification number. The MC9S08QD4 series is hard coded to the value 0x011. See also ID bits in Table 5-9. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 64 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ID7 ID6 ID5 ID4 ID3 ID2 ID1 ID0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 1 W Reset: = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 5-8. System Device Identification Register — Low (SDIDL) Table 5-9. SDIDL Register Field Descriptions Field 7:0 ID[7:0] 5.8.7 Description Part Identification Number — Each derivative in the HCS08 family has a unique identification number. The MC9S08QD4 series is hard coded to the value 0x011. See also ID bits in Table 5-8. System Real-Time Interrupt Status and Control Register (SRTISC) This high-page register contains status and control bits for the RTI. R 7 6 RTIF 0 W Reset: 5 4 RTICLKS RTIE 0 0 3 2 1 0 0 RTIS RTIACK 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 5-9. System RTI Status and Control Register (SRTISC) Table 5-10. SRTISC Register Field Descriptions Field 7 RTIF Description Real-Time Interrupt Flag — This read-only status bit indicates the periodic wakeup timer has timed out. 0 Periodic wakeup timer not timed out. 1 Periodic wakeup timer timed out. 6 RTIACK Real-Time Interrupt Acknowledge — This write-only bit is used to acknowledge real-time interrupt request (write 1 to clear RTIF). Writing 0 has no meaning or effect. Reads always return 0. 5 RTICLKS Real-Time Interrupt Clock Select — This read/write bit selects the clock source for the real-time interrupt. 0 Real-time interrupt request clock source is internal 1 kHz oscillator. 1 Real-time interrupt request clock source is 32 kHz ICS clock. 4 RTIE Real-Time Interrupt Enable — This read-write bit enables real-time interrupts. 0 Real-time interrupts disabled. 1 Real-time interrupts enabled. 2:0 RTIS Real-Time Interrupt Delay Selects — These read/write bits select the period for the RTI. See Table 5-11 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 65 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control Table 5-11. Real-Time Interrupt Period RTIS2:RTIS1:RTIS0 Using Internal 1 kHz Clock Source1 2 Using 32 kHz ICS Clock Source Period = text3 0:0:0 Disable RTI Disable RTI 0:0:1 8 ms text × 256 0:1:0 32 ms text × 1024 0:1:1 64 ms text × 2048 1:0:0 128 ms text × 4096 1:0:1 256 ms text × 8192 1:1:0 512 ms text × 16384 1:1:1 1.024 s text × 32768 1 Values are shown in this column based on tRTI = 1 ms. See tRTI in the Section A.8.1, “Control Timing,” for the tolerance of this value. 2 The initial RTI timeout period will be up to one 1 kHz clock period less than the time specified. 3 t ext is the period of the 32 kHz ICS frequency. 5.8.8 System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1) This high-page register contains status and control bits to support the low voltage detect function, and to enable the bandgap voltage reference for use by the ADC module. To configure the low voltage detect trip voltage, see Table 5-13 for the LVDV bit description in SPMSC2. R 7 6 LVDF 0 W Reset: 5 4 3 2 LVDIE LVDRE2 LVDSE LVDE 2 0 1 1 1 1 1 0 0 BGBE LVDACK 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved 1 Bit 1 is a reserved bit that must always be written to 0. 2 This bit can be written only one time after reset. Additional writes are ignored. Figure 5-10. System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1) Table 5-12. SPMSC1 Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 LVDF Low-Voltage Detect Flag — Provided LVDE = 1, this read-only status bit indicates a low-voltage detect event. 6 LVDACK Low-Voltage Detect Acknowledge — This write-only bit is used to acknowledge low voltage detection errors (write 1 to clear LVDF). Reads always return 0. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 66 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control Table 5-12. SPMSC1 Register Field Descriptions (continued) Field Description 5 LVDIE Low-Voltage Detect Interrupt Enable — This bit enables hardware interrupt requests for LVDF. 0 Hardware interrupt disabled (use polling). 1 Request a hardware interrupt when LVDF = 1. 4 LVDRE Low-Voltage Detect Reset Enable — This write-once bit enables LVDF events to generate a hardware reset (provided LVDE = 1). 0 LVDF does not generate hardware resets. 1 Force an MCU reset when LVDF = 1. 3 LVDSE Low-Voltage Detect Stop Enable — Provided LVDE = 1, this read/write bit determines whether the low-voltage detect function operates when the MCU is in stop mode. 0 Low-voltage detect disabled during stop mode. 1 Low-voltage detect enabled during stop mode. 2 LVDE Low-Voltage Detect Enable — This write-once bit enables low-voltage detect logic and qualifies the operation of other bits in this register. 0 LVD logic disabled. 1 LVD logic enabled. 0 BGBE Bandgap Buffer Enable — This bit enables an internal buffer for the bandgap voltage reference for use by the ADC module on one of its internal channels. 0 Bandgap buffer disabled. 1 Bandgap buffer enabled. 5.8.9 System Power Management Status and Control 2 Register (SPMSC2) This high-page register contains status and control bits to configure the stop mode behavior of the MCU. See Section 3.6, “Stop Modes,” for more information on stop modes. R 7 6 LVWF 0 5 4 LVDV LVWV PPDF 0 1 0 PPDC1 PPDACK POR: 02 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 LVDR: 0 2 0 U U 0 0 0 0 Other Reset 02 0 U U 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved 2 2 LVWACK W 1 3 U = Unaffected by reset This bit can be written only one time after reset. Additional writes are ignored. LVWF will be set in the case when Vsupply transitions below the trip point or after reset and Vsupply is already below VLVW. Figure 5-11. System Power Management Status and Control 2 Register (SPMSC2) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 67 Chapter 5 Resets, Interrupts, and General System Control Table 5-13. SPMSC2 Register Field Descriptions Field 7 LVWF 6 LVWACK Description Low-Voltage Warning Flag — The LVWF bit indicates the low voltage warning status. 0 Low voltage warning not preset. 1 Low voltage warning is present or was present. Low-Voltage Warning Acknowledge — The LVWACK bit is the low-voltage warning acknowledge. Writing a 1 to LVWACK clears LVWF to a 0 if a low voltage warning is not present. 5 LVDV Low-Voltage Detect Voltage Select — The LVDV bit selects the LVD trip point voltage (VLVD). 0 Low trip point selected (VLVD = VLVDL). 1 High trip point selected (VLVD = VLVDH). 4 LVWV Low-Voltage Warning Voltage Select — The LVWV bit selects the LVW trip point voltage (VLVW). 0 Low trip point selected (VLVW = VLVWL). 1 High trip point selected (VLVW = VLVWH). 3 PPDF Partial Power Down Flag — The PPDF bit indicates that the MCU has exited the stop2 mode. 0 Not stop2 mode recovery. 1 Stop2 mode recovery. 2 PPDACK 0 PPDC Partial Power Down Acknowledge — Writing a 1 to PPDACK clears the PPDF bit. Partial Power Down Control — The write-once PPDC bit controls whether stop2 or stop3 mode is selected. 0 Stop3 mode enabled. 1 Stop2, partial power down, mode enabled. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 68 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control This section explains software controls related to parallel input/output (I/O) and pin control. The MC9S08QD4 series has one parallel I/O port which include a total of 4 I/O pins, one output-only pin, and one input-only pin. See Section Chapter 2, “External Signal Description,” for more information about pin assignments and external hardware considerations of these pins. All of these I/O pins are shared with on-chip peripheral functions as shown in Table 2-1. The peripheral modules have priority over the I/Os so that when a peripheral is enabled, the I/O functions associated with the shared pins are disabled. After reset, the shared peripheral functions are disabled so that the pins are controlled by the I/O. All of the I/Os are configured as inputs (PTxDDn = 0) with pullup devices disabled (PTxPEn = 0), except for output-only pin PTA4 which defaults to BKGD/MS pin. NOTE Not all general-purpose I/O pins are available on all packages. To avoid extra current drain from floating input pins, the user’s reset initialization routine in the application program must either enable on-chip pullup devices or change the direction of unconnected pins to outputs so the pins do not float. 6.1 Port Data and Data Direction Reading and writing of parallel I/Os is performed through the port data registers. The direction, either input or output, is controlled through the port data direction registers. The parallel I/O port function for an individual pin is illustrated in the block diagram shown in Figure 6-1. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 69 Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control PTxDDn D Output Enable Q PTxDn D Output Data Q 1 Port Read Data 0 Input Data Synchronizer BUSCLK Figure 6-1. Parallel I/O Block Diagram The data direction control bit (PTxDDn) determines whether the output buffer for the associated pin is enabled, and also controls the source for port data register reads. The input buffer for the associated pin is always enabled unless the pin is enabled as an analog function or is an output-only pin. When a shared digital function is enabled for a pin, the output buffer is controlled by the shared function. However, the data direction register bit will continue to control the source for reads of the port data register. When a shared analog function is enabled for a pin, both the input and output buffers are disabled. A value of 0 is read for any port data bit where the bit is an input (PTxDDn = 0) and the input buffer is disabled. In general, whenever a pin is shared with both an alternate digital function and an analog function, the analog function has priority such that if both the digital and analog functions are enabled, the analog function controls the pin. It is a good programming practice to write to the port data register before changing the direction of a port pin to become an output. This ensures that the pin will not be driven momentarily with an old data value that happened to be in the port data register. 6.2 Pin Control — Pullup, Slew Rate and Drive Strength Associated with the parallel I/O ports is a set of registers located in the high-page register space that operate independently of the parallel I/O registers. These registers are used to control pullups, slew rate and drive strength for the pins. 6.3 Pin Behavior in Stop Modes Pin behavior following execution of a STOP instruction depends on the stop mode that is entered. An explanation of pin behavior for the various stop modes follows: MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 70 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control • In stop1 mode, all internal registers including parallel I/O control and data registers are powered off. Each of the pins assumes its default reset state (output buffer and internal pullup disabled). Upon exit from stop1, all pins must be re-configured the same as if the MCU had been reset. Stop2 mode is a partial power-down mode, whereby latches maintain the pin state as before the STOP instruction was executed. CPU register status and the state of I/O registers must be saved in RAM before the STOP instruction is executed to place the MCU in stop2 mode. Upon recovery from stop2 mode, before accessing any I/O, the user must examine the state of the PPDF bit in the SPMSC2 register. If the PPDF bit is 0, I/O must be initialized as if a power on reset had occurred. If the PPDF bit is 1, I/O data previously stored in RAM, before the STOP instruction was executed, peripherals previously enabled will require being initialized and restored to their pre-stop condition. The user must then write a 1 to the PPDACK bit in the SPMSC2 register. Access of pins is now permitted again in the user’s application program. In stop3 mode, all pin states are maintained because internal logic stays powered up. Upon recovery, all pin functions are the same as before entering stop3. • • 6.4 Parallel I/O Registers 6.4.1 Port A Registers This section provides information about the registers associated with the parallel I/O ports. Refer to tables in Chapter 4, “Memory Map and Register Definition,” for the absolute address assignments for all parallel I/O. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A Freescale Semiconductor-provided equate or header file normally is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses. 6.4.1.1 R Port A Data (PTAD) 7 6 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PTAD51 PTAD42 PTAD3 PTAD2 PTAD1 PTAD0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset: 0 0 1 Reads of bit PTAD5 always return the pin value of PTA5, regardless of the value stored in bit PTADD5. 2 Reads of bit PTAD4 always return the contents of PTAD4, regardless of the value stored in bit PTADD4. Figure 6-2. Port A Data Register (PTAD) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 71 Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control Table 6-1. PTAD Register Field Descriptions Field Description 5:0 PTAD[5:0] Port A Data Register Bits — For port A pins that are inputs, reads return the logic level on the pin. For port A pins that are configured as outputs, reads return the last value written to this register. Writes are latched into all bits of this register. For port A pins that are configured as outputs, the logic level is driven out the corresponding MCU pin. Reset forces PTAD to all 0s, but these 0s are not driven out the corresponding pins because reset also configures all port pins as high-impedance inputs with pullups disabled. 6.4.1.2 R Port A Data Direction (PTADD) 7 6 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PTADD51 PTADD42 PTADD3 PTADD2 PTADD1 PTADD0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset: 0 0 1 PTADD5 has no effect on the input-only PTA5 pin. Read this bit is always equal to zero. 2 PTADD4 has no effect on the output-only PTA4 pin. Figure 6-3. Port A Data Direction Register (PTADD) Table 6-2. PTADD Register Field Descriptions Field Description 5:0 Data Direction for Port A Bits — These read/write bits control the direction of port A pins and what is read for PTADD[5:0] PTAD reads. 0 Input (output driver disabled) and reads return the pin value. 1 Output driver enabled for port A bit n and PTAD reads return the contents of PTADn. 6.4.2 Port A Control Registers The pins associated with port A are controlled by the registers in this section. These registers control the pin pullup, slew rate and drive strength of the Port A pins independent of the parallel I/O register. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 72 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control 6.4.2.1 Port A Internal Pullup Enable (PTAPE) An internal pullup device can be enabled for each port pin by setting the corresponding bit in the pullup enable register (PTAPEn). The pullup device is disabled if the pin is configured as an output by the parallel I/O control logic or any shared peripheral function regardless of the state of the corresponding pullup enable register bit. The pullup device is also disabled if the pin is controlled by an analog function. R 7 6 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PTAPE5 PTAPE41 PTAPE3 PTAPE2 PTAPE1 PTAPE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset: 1 0 0 PTAPE4 has no effect on the output-only PTA4 pin. Figure 6-4. Internal Pullup Enable for Port A Register (PTAPE) Table 6-3. PTAPE Register Field Descriptions Field Description 5:0 Internal Pullup Enable for Port A Bits — Each of these control bits determines if the internal pullup device is PTAPE[5:0] enabled for the associated PTA pin. For port A pins that are configured as outputs, these bits have no effect and the internal pullup devices are disabled. 0 Internal pullup device disabled for port A bit n. 1 Internal pullup device enabled for port A bit n. 6.4.2.2 Port A Slew Rate Enable (PTASE) Slew rate control can be enabled for each port pin by setting the corresponding bit in the slew rate control register (PTASEn). When enabled, slew control limits the rate at which an output can transition in order to reduce EMC emissions. Slew rate control has no effect on pins which are configured as inputs. R 7 6 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PTASE51 PTASE4 PTASE3 PTASE2 PTASE1 PTASE0 1 1 1 1 1 1 W Reset: 1 0 0 PTASE5 has no effect on the input-only PTA5 pin. Figure 6-5. Slew Rate Enable for Port A Register (PTASE) Table 6-4. PTASE Register Field Descriptions Field Description 5:0 Output Slew Rate Enable for Port A Bits — Each of these control bits determines if the output slew rate control PTASE[5:0] is enabled for the associated PTA pin. For port A pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have no effect. 0 Output slew rate control disabled for port A bit n. 1 Output slew rate control enabled for port A bit n. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 73 Chapter 6 Parallel Input/Output Control 6.4.2.3 Port A Drive Strength Select (PTADS) An output pin can be selected to have high output drive strength by setting the corresponding bit in the drive strength select register (PTADSn). When high drive is selected a pin is capable of sourcing and sinking greater current. Even though every I/O pin can be selected as high drive, the user must ensure that the total current source and sink limits for the chip are not exceeded. Drive strength selection is intended to affect the DC behavior of I/O pins. However, the AC behavior is also affected. High drive allows a pin to drive a greater load with the same switching speed as a low drive enabled pin into a smaller load. Because of this the EMC emissions may be affected by enabling pins as high drive. 6.4.2.4 R Port A Drive Strength Select (PTADS) 7 6 0 0 5 4 3 2 1 0 PTADS51 PTADS4 PTADS3 PTADS2 PTADS1 PTADS0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset: 1 0 0 PTADS5 has no effect on the input-only PTA5 pin. Figure 6-6. Drive Strength Selection for Port A Register (PTADS) Table 6-5. PTADS Register Field Descriptions Field Description 5:0 Output Drive Strength Selection for Port A Bits — Each of these control bits selects between low and high PTADS[5:0] output drive for the associated PTA pin. For port A pins that are configured as inputs, these bits have no effect. 0 Low output drive strength selected for port A bit n. 1 High output drive strength selected for port A bit n. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 74 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.1 Introduction This section provides summary information about the registers, addressing modes, and instruction set of the CPU of the HCS08 Family. For a more detailed discussion, refer to the HCS08 Family Reference Manual, volume 1, Freescale Semiconductor document order number HCS08RMV1/D. The HCS08 CPU is fully source- and object-code-compatible with the M68HC08 CPU. Several instructions and enhanced addressing modes were added to improve C compiler efficiency and to support a new background debug system which replaces the monitor mode of earlier M68HC08 microcontrollers (MCU). 7.1.1 Features Features of the HCS08 CPU include: • Object code fully upward-compatible with M68HC05 and M68HC08 Families • All registers and memory are mapped to a single 64-Kbyte address space • 16-bit stack pointer (any size stack anywhere in 64-Kbyte address space) • 16-bit index register (H:X) with powerful indexed addressing modes • 8-bit accumulator (A) • Many instructions treat X as a second general-purpose 8-bit register • Seven addressing modes: — Inherent — Operands in internal registers — Relative — 8-bit signed offset to branch destination — Immediate — Operand in next object code byte(s) — Direct — Operand in memory at 0x0000–0x00FF — Extended — Operand anywhere in 64-Kbyte address space — Indexed relative to H:X — Five submodes including auto increment — Indexed relative to SP — Improves C efficiency dramatically • Memory-to-memory data move instructions with four address mode combinations • Overflow, half-carry, negative, zero, and carry condition codes support conditional branching on the results of signed, unsigned, and binary-coded decimal (BCD) operations • Efficient bit manipulation instructions • Fast 8-bit by 8-bit multiply and 16-bit by 8-bit divide instructions • STOP and WAIT instructions to invoke low-power operating modes MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 75 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.2 Programmer’s Model and CPU Registers Figure 7-1 shows the five CPU registers. CPU registers are not part of the memory map. 7 0 ACCUMULATOR A 16-BIT INDEX REGISTER H:X H INDEX REGISTER (HIGH) 8 15 INDEX REGISTER (LOW) 7 X 0 SP STACK POINTER 0 15 PROGRAM COUNTER 7 0 CONDITION CODE REGISTER V 1 1 H I N Z C PC CCR CARRY ZERO NEGATIVE INTERRUPT MASK HALF-CARRY (FROM BIT 3) TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW Figure 7-1. CPU Registers 7.2.1 Accumulator (A) The A accumulator is a general-purpose 8-bit register. One operand input to the arithmetic logic unit (ALU) is connected to the accumulator and the ALU results are often stored into the A accumulator after arithmetic and logical operations. The accumulator can be loaded from memory using various addressing modes to specify the address where the loaded data comes from, or the contents of A can be stored to memory using various addressing modes to specify the address where data from A will be stored. Reset has no effect on the contents of the A accumulator. 7.2.2 Index Register (H:X) This 16-bit register is actually two separate 8-bit registers (H and X), which often work together as a 16-bit address pointer where H holds the upper byte of an address and X holds the lower byte of the address. All indexed addressing mode instructions use the full 16-bit value in H:X as an index reference pointer; however, for compatibility with the earlier M68HC05 Family, some instructions operate only on the low-order 8-bit half (X). Many instructions treat X as a second general-purpose 8-bit register that can be used to hold 8-bit data values. X can be cleared, incremented, decremented, complemented, negated, shifted, or rotated. Transfer instructions allow data to be transferred from A or transferred to A where arithmetic and logical operations can then be performed. For compatibility with the earlier M68HC05 Family, H is forced to 0x00 during reset. Reset has no effect on the contents of X. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 76 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.2.3 Stack Pointer (SP) This 16-bit address pointer register points at the next available location on the automatic last-in-first-out (LIFO) stack. The stack may be located anywhere in the 64-Kbyte address space that has RAM and can be any size up to the amount of available RAM. The stack is used to automatically save the return address for subroutine calls, the return address and CPU registers during interrupts, and for local variables. The AIS (add immediate to stack pointer) instruction adds an 8-bit signed immediate value to SP. This is most often used to allocate or deallocate space for local variables on the stack. SP is forced to 0x00FF at reset for compatibility with the earlier M68HC05 Family. HCS08 programs normally change the value in SP to the address of the last location (highest address) in on-chip RAM during reset initialization to free up direct page RAM (from the end of the on-chip registers to 0x00FF). The RSP (reset stack pointer) instruction was included for compatibility with the M68HC05 Family and is seldom used in new HCS08 programs because it only affects the low-order half of the stack pointer. 7.2.4 Program Counter (PC) The program counter is a 16-bit register that contains the address of the next instruction or operand to be fetched. During normal program execution, the program counter automatically increments to the next sequential memory location every time an instruction or operand is fetched. Jump, branch, interrupt, and return operations load the program counter with an address other than that of the next sequential location. This is called a change-of-flow. During reset, the program counter is loaded with the reset vector that is located at 0xFFFE and 0xFFFF. The vector stored there is the address of the first instruction that will be executed after exiting the reset state. 7.2.5 Condition Code Register (CCR) The 8-bit condition code register contains the interrupt mask (I) and five flags that indicate the results of the instruction just executed. Bits 6 and 5 are set permanently to 1. The following paragraphs describe the functions of the condition code bits in general terms. For a more detailed explanation of how each instruction sets the CCR bits, refer to the HCS08 Family Reference Manual, volume 1, Freescale Semiconductor document order number HCS08RMv1. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 77 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7 0 CONDITION CODE REGISTER V 1 1 H I N Z C CCR CARRY ZERO NEGATIVE INTERRUPT MASK HALF-CARRY (FROM BIT 3) TWO’S COMPLEMENT OVERFLOW Figure 7-2. Condition Code Register Table 7-1. CCR Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 V Two’s Complement Overflow Flag — The CPU sets the overflow flag when a two’s complement overflow occurs. The signed branch instructions BGT, BGE, BLE, and BLT use the overflow flag. 0 No overflow 1 Overflow 4 H Half-Carry Flag — The CPU sets the half-carry flag when a carry occurs between accumulator bits 3 and 4 during an add-without-carry (ADD) or add-with-carry (ADC) operation. The half-carry flag is required for binary-coded decimal (BCD) arithmetic operations. The DAA instruction uses the states of the H and C condition code bits to automatically add a correction value to the result from a previous ADD or ADC on BCD operands to correct the result to a valid BCD value. 0 No carry between bits 3 and 4 1 Carry between bits 3 and 4 3 I Interrupt Mask Bit — When the interrupt mask is set, all maskable CPU interrupts are disabled. CPU interrupts are enabled when the interrupt mask is cleared. When a CPU interrupt occurs, the interrupt mask is set automatically after the CPU registers are saved on the stack, but before the first instruction of the interrupt service routine is executed. Interrupts are not recognized at the instruction boundary after any instruction that clears I (CLI or TAP). This ensures that the next instruction after a CLI or TAP will always be executed without the possibility of an intervening interrupt, provided I was set. 0 Interrupts enabled 1 Interrupts disabled 2 N Negative Flag — The CPU sets the negative flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation produces a negative result, setting bit 7 of the result. Simply loading or storing an 8-bit or 16-bit value causes N to be set if the most significant bit of the loaded or stored value was 1. 0 Non-negative result 1 Negative result 1 Z Zero Flag — The CPU sets the zero flag when an arithmetic operation, logic operation, or data manipulation produces a result of 0x00 or 0x0000. Simply loading or storing an 8-bit or 16-bit value causes Z to be set if the loaded or stored value was all 0s. 0 Non-zero result 1 Zero result 0 C Carry/Borrow Flag — The CPU sets the carry/borrow flag when an addition operation produces a carry out of bit 7 of the accumulator or when a subtraction operation requires a borrow. Some instructions — such as bit test and branch, shift, and rotate — also clear or set the carry/borrow flag. 0 No carry out of bit 7 1 Carry out of bit 7 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 78 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.3 Addressing Modes Addressing modes define the way the CPU accesses operands and data. In the HCS08, all memory, status and control registers, and input/output (I/O) ports share a single 64-Kbyte linear address space so a 16-bit binary address can uniquely identify any memory location. This arrangement means that the same instructions that access variables in RAM can also be used to access I/O and control registers or nonvolatile program space. Some instructions use more than one addressing mode. For instance, move instructions use one addressing mode to specify the source operand and a second addressing mode to specify the destination address. Instructions such as BRCLR, BRSET, CBEQ, and DBNZ use one addressing mode to specify the location of an operand for a test and then use relative addressing mode to specify the branch destination address when the tested condition is true. For BRCLR, BRSET, CBEQ, and DBNZ, the addressing mode listed in the instruction set tables is the addressing mode needed to access the operand to be tested, and relative addressing mode is implied for the branch destination. 7.3.1 Inherent Addressing Mode (INH) In this addressing mode, operands needed to complete the instruction (if any) are located within CPU registers so the CPU does not need to access memory to get any operands. 7.3.2 Relative Addressing Mode (REL) Relative addressing mode is used to specify the destination location for branch instructions. A signed 8-bit offset value is located in the memory location immediately following the opcode. During execution, if the branch condition is true, the signed offset is sign-extended to a 16-bit value and is added to the current contents of the program counter, which causes program execution to continue at the branch destination address. 7.3.3 Immediate Addressing Mode (IMM) In immediate addressing mode, the operand needed to complete the instruction is included in the object code immediately following the instruction opcode in memory. In the case of a 16-bit immediate operand, the high-order byte is located in the next memory location after the opcode, and the low-order byte is located in the next memory location after that. 7.3.4 Direct Addressing Mode (DIR) In direct addressing mode, the instruction includes the low-order eight bits of an address in the direct page (0x0000–0x00FF). During execution a 16-bit address is formed by concatenating an implied 0x00 for the high-order half of the address and the direct address from the instruction to get the 16-bit address where the desired operand is located. This is faster and more memory efficient than specifying a complete 16-bit address for the operand. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 79 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.3.5 Extended Addressing Mode (EXT) In extended addressing mode, the full 16-bit address of the operand is located in the next two bytes of program memory after the opcode (high byte first). 7.3.6 Indexed Addressing Mode Indexed addressing mode has seven variations including five that use the 16-bit H:X index register pair and two that use the stack pointer as the base reference. 7.3.6.1 Indexed, No Offset (IX) This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction. 7.3.6.2 Indexed, No Offset with Post Increment (IX+) This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction. The index register pair is then incremented (H:X = H:X + 0x0001) after the operand has been fetched. This addressing mode is only used for MOV and CBEQ instructions. 7.3.6.3 Indexed, 8-Bit Offset (IX1) This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair plus an unsigned 8-bit offset included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction. 7.3.6.4 Indexed, 8-Bit Offset with Post Increment (IX1+) This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair plus an unsigned 8-bit offset included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction. The index register pair is then incremented (H:X = H:X + 0x0001) after the operand has been fetched. This addressing mode is used only for the CBEQ instruction. 7.3.6.5 Indexed, 16-Bit Offset (IX2) This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the H:X index register pair plus a 16-bit offset included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction. 7.3.6.6 SP-Relative, 8-Bit Offset (SP1) This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the stack pointer (SP) plus an unsigned 8-bit offset included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 80 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.3.6.7 SP-Relative, 16-Bit Offset (SP2) This variation of indexed addressing uses the 16-bit value in the stack pointer (SP) plus a 16-bit offset included in the instruction as the address of the operand needed to complete the instruction. 7.4 Special Operations The CPU performs a few special operations that are similar to instructions but do not have opcodes like other CPU instructions. In addition, a few instructions such as STOP and WAIT directly affect other MCU circuitry. This section provides additional information about these operations. 7.4.1 Reset Sequence Reset can be caused by a power-on-reset (POR) event, internal conditions such as the COP (computer operating properly) watchdog, or by assertion of an external active-low reset pin. When a reset event occurs, the CPU immediately stops whatever it is doing (the MCU does not wait for an instruction boundary before responding to a reset event). For a more detailed discussion about how the MCU recognizes resets and determines the source, refer to the Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration chapter. The reset event is considered concluded when the sequence to determine whether the reset came from an internal source is done and when the reset pin is no longer asserted. At the conclusion of a reset event, the CPU performs a 6-cycle sequence to fetch the reset vector from 0xFFFE and 0xFFFF and to fill the instruction queue in preparation for execution of the first program instruction. 7.4.2 Interrupt Sequence When an interrupt is requested, the CPU completes the current instruction before responding to the interrupt. At this point, the program counter is pointing at the start of the next instruction, which is where the CPU should return after servicing the interrupt. The CPU responds to an interrupt by performing the same sequence of operations as for a software interrupt (SWI) instruction, except the address used for the vector fetch is determined by the highest priority interrupt that is pending when the interrupt sequence started. The CPU sequence for an interrupt is: 1. Store the contents of PCL, PCH, X, A, and CCR on the stack, in that order. 2. Set the I bit in the CCR. 3. Fetch the high-order half of the interrupt vector. 4. Fetch the low-order half of the interrupt vector. 5. Delay for one free bus cycle. 6. Fetch three bytes of program information starting at the address indicated by the interrupt vector to fill the instruction queue in preparation for execution of the first instruction in the interrupt service routine. After the CCR contents are pushed onto the stack, the I bit in the CCR is set to prevent other interrupts while in the interrupt service routine. Although it is possible to clear the I bit with an instruction in the MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 81 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) interrupt service routine, this would allow nesting of interrupts (which is not recommended because it leads to programs that are difficult to debug and maintain). For compatibility with the earlier M68HC05 MCUs, the high-order half of the H:X index register pair (H) is not saved on the stack as part of the interrupt sequence. The user must use a PSHH instruction at the beginning of the service routine to save H and then use a PULH instruction just before the RTI that ends the interrupt service routine. It is not necessary to save H if you are certain that the interrupt service routine does not use any instructions or auto-increment addressing modes that might change the value of H. The software interrupt (SWI) instruction is like a hardware interrupt except that it is not masked by the global I bit in the CCR and it is associated with an instruction opcode within the program so it is not asynchronous to program execution. 7.4.3 Wait Mode Operation The WAIT instruction enables interrupts by clearing the I bit in the CCR. It then halts the clocks to the CPU to reduce overall power consumption while the CPU is waiting for the interrupt or reset event that will wake the CPU from wait mode. When an interrupt or reset event occurs, the CPU clocks will resume and the interrupt or reset event will be processed normally. If a serial BACKGROUND command is issued to the MCU through the background debug interface while the CPU is in wait mode, CPU clocks will resume and the CPU will enter active background mode where other serial background commands can be processed. This ensures that a host development system can still gain access to a target MCU even if it is in wait mode. 7.4.4 Stop Mode Operation Usually, all system clocks, including the crystal oscillator (when used), are halted during stop mode to minimize power consumption. In such systems, external circuitry is needed to control the time spent in stop mode and to issue a signal to wake up the target MCU when it is time to resume processing. Unlike the earlier M68HC05 and M68HC08 MCUs, the HCS08 can be configured to keep a minimum set of clocks running in stop mode. This optionally allows an internal periodic signal to wake the target MCU from stop mode. When a host debug system is connected to the background debug pin (BKGD) and the ENBDM control bit has been set by a serial command through the background interface (or because the MCU was reset into active background mode), the oscillator is forced to remain active when the MCU enters stop mode. In this case, if a serial BACKGROUND command is issued to the MCU through the background debug interface while the CPU is in stop mode, CPU clocks will resume and the CPU will enter active background mode where other serial background commands can be processed. This ensures that a host development system can still gain access to a target MCU even if it is in stop mode. Recovery from stop mode depends on the particular HCS08 and whether the oscillator was stopped in stop mode. Refer to the Modes of Operation chapter for more details. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 82 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.4.5 BGND Instruction The BGND instruction is new to the HCS08 compared to the M68HC08. BGND would not be used in normal user programs because it forces the CPU to stop processing user instructions and enter the active background mode. The only way to resume execution of the user program is through reset or by a host debug system issuing a GO, TRACE1, or TAGGO serial command through the background debug interface. Software-based breakpoints can be set by replacing an opcode at the desired breakpoint address with the BGND opcode. When the program reaches this breakpoint address, the CPU is forced to active background mode rather than continuing the user program. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 83 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) 7.5 HCS08 Instruction Set Summary Table 7-2 provides a summary of the HCS08 instruction set in all possible addressing modes. The table shows operand construction, execution time in internal bus clock cycles, and cycle-by-cycle details for each addressing mode variation of each instruction. Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 1 of 9) ADC ADC ADC ADC ADC ADC ADC ADC #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP ADD ADD ADD ADD ADD ADD ADD ADD #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP Add with Carry A ← (A) + (M) + (C) Add without Carry A ← (A) + (M) Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 A9 B9 C9 D9 E9 F9 9E D9 9E E9 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 AB BB CB DB EB FB 9E DB 9E EB ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff ee ff ff Cyc-by-Cyc Details Affect on CCR VH I N Z C 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp – 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp – AIS #opr8i Add Immediate Value (Signed) to Stack Pointer SP ← (SP) + (M) IMM A7 ii 2 pp –– – – – – AIX #opr8i Add Immediate Value (Signed) to Index Register (H:X) H:X ← (H:X) + (M) IMM AF ii 2 pp –– – – – – Logical AND A ← (A) & (M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 A4 B4 C4 D4 E4 F4 9E D4 9E E4 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp 0– – DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 38 dd 48 58 68 ff 78 9E 68 ff 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp – – DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 37 dd 47 57 67 ff 77 9E 67 ff 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp – – REL 24 rr 3 ppp AND AND AND AND AND AND AND AND #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP ASL opr8a ASLA ASLX ASL oprx8,X ASL ,X ASL oprx8,SP ASR opr8a ASRA ASRX ASR oprx8,X ASR ,X ASR oprx8,SP BCC rel Arithmetic Shift Left C 0 b7 b0 (Same as LSL) Arithmetic Shift Right C b7 b0 Branch if Carry Bit Clear (if C = 0) ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff – –– – – – – MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 84 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 2 of 9) Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form Cyc-by-Cyc Details Affect on CCR VH I N Z C 11 13 15 17 19 1B 1D 1F dd dd dd dd dd dd dd dd 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp –– – – – – BCLR n,opr8a Clear Bit n in Memory (Mn ← 0) DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) BCS rel Branch if Carry Bit Set (if C = 1) (Same as BLO) REL 25 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BEQ rel Branch if Equal (if Z = 1) REL 27 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BGE rel Branch if Greater Than or Equal To (if N ⊕ V = 0) (Signed) REL 90 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BGND Enter active background if ENBDM=1 Waits for and processes BDM commands until GO, TRACE1, or TAGGO INH 82 5+ fp...ppp –– – – – – BGT rel Branch if Greater Than (if Z | (N ⊕ V) = 0) (Signed) REL 92 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BHCC rel Branch if Half Carry Bit Clear (if H = 0) REL 28 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BHCS rel Branch if Half Carry Bit Set (if H = 1) REL 29 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BHI rel Branch if Higher (if C | Z = 0) REL 22 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BHS rel Branch if Higher or Same (if C = 0) (Same as BCC) REL 24 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BIH rel Branch if IRQ Pin High (if IRQ pin = 1) REL 2F rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BIL rel Branch if IRQ Pin Low (if IRQ pin = 0) REL 2E rr 3 ppp –– – – – – Bit Test (A) & (M) (CCR Updated but Operands Not Changed) IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp 0– – BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT BIT #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP A5 B5 C5 D5 E5 F5 9E D5 9E E5 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff – BLE rel Branch if Less Than or Equal To (if Z | (N ⊕ V) = 1) (Signed) REL 93 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BLO rel Branch if Lower (if C = 1) (Same as BCS) REL 25 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BLS rel Branch if Lower or Same (if C | Z = 1) REL 23 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BLT rel Branch if Less Than (if N ⊕ V = 1) (Signed) REL 91 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BMC rel Branch if Interrupt Mask Clear (if I = 0) REL 2C rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BMI rel Branch if Minus (if N = 1) REL 2B rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BMS rel Branch if Interrupt Mask Set (if I = 1) REL 2D rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BNE rel Branch if Not Equal (if Z = 0) REL 26 rr 3 ppp –– – – – – BPL rel Branch if Plus (if N = 0) REL 2A rr 3 ppp –– – – – – MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 85 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 3 of 9) BRA rel Branch Always (if I = 1) BRCLR n,opr8a,rel DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) Branch if Bit n in Memory Clear (if (Mn) = 0) DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) 01 03 05 07 09 0B 0D 0F BRN rel Branch Never (if I = 0) REL 21 rr Branch if Bit n in Memory Set (if (Mn) = 1) DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) 00 02 04 06 08 0A 0C 0E dd dd dd dd dd dd dd dd BSET n,opr8a Set Bit n in Memory (Mn ← 1) DIR (b0) DIR (b1) DIR (b2) DIR (b3) DIR (b4) DIR (b5) DIR (b6) DIR (b7) 10 12 14 16 18 1A 1C 1E BSR rel Branch to Subroutine PC ← (PC) + $0002 push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – $0001 push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – $0001 PC ← (PC) + rel REL BRSET n,opr8a,rel Branch if (A) = (M) Branch if (A) = (M) Branch if (X) = (M) Branch if (A) = (M) Branch if (A) = (M) Branch if (A) = (M) REL Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form DIR IMM IMM IX1+ IX+ SP1 Cyc-by-Cyc Details Affect on CCR VH I N Z C 3 ppp –– – – – – 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp –– – – – 3 ppp –– – – – – 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp rpppp –– – – – dd dd dd dd dd dd dd dd 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 5 rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp rfwpp –– – – – – AD rr 5 ssppp –– – – – – 5 4 4 5 5 6 rpppp pppp pppp rpppp rfppp prpppp –– – – – – 20 rr dd dd dd dd dd dd dd dd rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr rr CBEQ opr8a,rel CBEQA #opr8i,rel CBEQX #opr8i,rel CBEQ oprx8,X+,rel CBEQ ,X+,rel CBEQ oprx8,SP,rel Compare and... CLC Clear Carry Bit (C ← 0) INH 98 1 p –– – – – 0 CLI Clear Interrupt Mask Bit (I ← 0) INH 9A 1 p –– 0 – – – CLR opr8a CLRA CLRX CLRH CLR oprx8,X CLR ,X CLR oprx8,SP Clear DIR INH INH INH IX1 IX SP1 3F dd 4F 5F 8C 6F ff 7F 9E 6F ff 5 1 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp 0 – – 0 1– M ← $00 A ← $00 X ← $00 H ← $00 M ← $00 M ← $00 M ← $00 31 41 51 61 71 9E 61 dd ii ii ff rr ff rr rr rr rr rr MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 86 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 4 of 9) CMP CMP CMP CMP CMP CMP CMP CMP #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP Compare Accumulator with Memory A–M (CCR Updated But Operands Not Changed) Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 A1 B1 C1 D1 E1 F1 9E D1 9E E1 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff Cyc-by-Cyc Details Affect on CCR VH I N Z C 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp 0– – – – COM opr8a COMA COMX COM oprx8,X COM ,X COM oprx8,SP Complement M ← (M)= $FF – (M) (One’s Complement) A ← (A) = $FF – (A) X ← (X) = $FF – (X) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) M ← (M) = $FF – (M) DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 33 dd 43 53 63 ff 73 9E 63 ff CPHX opr16a CPHX #opr16i CPHX opr8a CPHX oprx8,SP Compare Index Register (H:X) with Memory (H:X) – (M:M + $0001) (CCR Updated But Operands Not Changed) EXT IMM DIR SP1 3E 65 75 9E F3 hh ll jj kk dd ff 6 3 5 6 prrfpp ppp rrfpp prrfpp – – Compare X (Index Register Low) with Memory X–M (CCR Updated But Operands Not Changed) IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 A3 B3 C3 D3 E3 F3 9E D3 9E E3 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp – – 1 p U– – 7 4 4 7 6 8 rfwpppp fppp fppp rfwpppp rfwppp prfwpppp –– – – – – CPX CPX CPX CPX CPX CPX CPX CPX #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP DAA Decimal Adjust Accumulator After ADD or ADC of BCD Values INH 72 DBNZ opr8a,rel DBNZA rel DBNZX rel DBNZ oprx8,X,rel DBNZ ,X,rel DBNZ oprx8,SP,rel DIR INH Decrement A, X, or M and Branch if Not Zero INH (if (result) ≠ 0) IX1 DBNZX Affects X Not H IX SP1 3B 4B 5B 6B 7B 9E 6B DEC opr8a DECA DECX DEC oprx8,X DEC ,X DEC oprx8,SP Decrement Divide A ← (H:A)÷(X); H ← Remainder DIV EOR EOR EOR EOR EOR EOR EOR EOR M ← (M) – $01 A ← (A) – $01 X ← (X) – $01 M ← (M) – $01 M ← (M) – $01 M ← (M) – $01 #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP Exclusive OR Memory with Accumulator A ← (A ⊕ M) ee ff ff dd rr rr rr ff rr rr ff rr DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 3A dd 4A 5A 6A ff 7A 9E 6A ff 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp – – INH 52 6 fffffp –– – – IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 A8 B8 C8 D8 E8 F8 9E D8 9E E8 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp 0– – ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff 1 – – MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 87 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 5 of 9) INC opr8a INCA INCX INC oprx8,X INC ,X INC oprx8,SP Increment M ← (M) + $01 A ← (A) + $01 X ← (X) + $01 M ← (M) + $01 M ← (M) + $01 M ← (M) + $01 Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form Cyc-by-Cyc Details Affect on CCR VH I N Z C 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp dd hh ll ee ff ff 3 4 4 3 3 ppp pppp pppp ppp ppp –– – – – – DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 3C dd 4C 5C 6C ff 7C 9E 6C ff BC CC DC EC FC – – – JMP JMP JMP JMP JMP opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X Jump PC ← Jump Address DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX JSR JSR JSR JSR JSR opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X Jump to Subroutine PC ← (PC) + n (n = 1, 2, or 3) Push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – $0001 Push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – $0001 PC ← Unconditional Address DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX BD CD DD ED FD dd hh ll ee ff ff 5 6 6 5 5 ssppp pssppp pssppp ssppp ssppp –– – – – – LDA LDA LDA LDA LDA LDA LDA LDA #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP Load Accumulator from Memory A ← (M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 A6 B6 C6 D6 E6 F6 9E D6 9E E6 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp 0– – – Load Index Register (H:X) H:X ← (M:M + $0001) IMM DIR EXT IX IX2 IX1 SP1 jj kk dd hh ll 9E 9E 9E 9E 45 55 32 AE BE CE FE 3 4 5 5 6 5 5 ppp rrpp prrpp prrfp pprrpp prrpp prrpp 0– – – Load X (Index Register Low) from Memory X ← (M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 AE BE CE DE EE FE 9E DE 9E EE ii dd hh ll ee ff ff 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp 0– – – DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 38 dd 48 58 68 ff 78 9E 68 ff 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp – – DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 34 dd 44 54 64 ff 74 9E 64 ff 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp – – 0 LDHX LDHX LDHX LDHX LDHX LDHX LDHX LDX LDX LDX LDX LDX LDX LDX LDX #opr16i opr8a opr16a ,X oprx16,X oprx8,X oprx8,SP #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP LSL opr8a LSLA LSLX LSL oprx8,X LSL ,X LSL oprx8,SP LSR opr8a LSRA LSRX LSR oprx8,X LSR ,X LSR oprx8,SP Logical Shift Left C 0 b7 b0 (Same as ASL) Logical Shift Right 0 C b7 b0 ee ff ff ee ff ff ff ee ff ff MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 88 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 6 of 9) Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form VH I N Z C rpwpp rfwpp pwpp rfwpp 0– – 42 5 ffffp –0 – – –0 DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 30 dd 40 50 60 ff 70 9E 60 ff 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp No Operation — Uses 1 Bus Cycle INH 9D 1 p –– – – – – Nibble Swap Accumulator A ← (A[3:0]:A[7:4]) INH 62 1 p –– – – – – Inclusive OR Accumulator and Memory A ← (A) | (M) IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 AA BA CA DA EA FA 9E DA 9E EA 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp 0– – Move (M)destination ← (M)source In IX+/DIR and DIR/IX+ Modes, H:X ← (H:X) + $0001 DIR/DIR DIR/IX+ IMM/DIR IX+/DIR 4E 5E 6E 7E MUL Unsigned multiply X:A ← (X) × (A) INH NEG opr8a NEGA NEGX NEG oprx8,X NEG ,X NEG oprx8,SP Negate M ← – (M) = $00 – (M) (Two’s Complement) A ← – (A) = $00 – (A) X ← – (X) = $00 – (X) M ← – (M) = $00 – (M) M ← – (M) = $00 – (M) M ← – (M) = $00 – (M) NOP NSA #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP Affect on CCR 5 5 4 5 MOV opr8a,opr8a MOV opr8a,X+ MOV #opr8i,opr8a MOV ,X+,opr8a ORA ORA ORA ORA ORA ORA ORA ORA Cyc-by-Cyc Details dd dd dd ii dd dd ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff – – – – PSHA Push Accumulator onto Stack Push (A); SP ← (SP) – $0001 INH 87 2 sp –– – – – – PSHH Push H (Index Register High) onto Stack Push (H); SP ← (SP) – $0001 INH 8B 2 sp –– – – – – PSHX Push X (Index Register Low) onto Stack Push (X); SP ← (SP) – $0001 INH 89 2 sp –– – – – – PULA Pull Accumulator from Stack SP ← (SP + $0001); Pull (A) INH 86 3 ufp –– – – – – PULH Pull H (Index Register High) from Stack SP ← (SP + $0001); Pull (H) INH 8A 3 ufp –– – – – – PULX Pull X (Index Register Low) from Stack SP ← (SP + $0001); Pull (X) INH 88 3 ufp –– – – – – DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 39 dd 49 59 69 ff 79 9E 69 ff 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp – – DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 36 dd 46 56 66 ff 76 9E 66 ff 5 1 1 5 4 6 rfwpp p p rfwpp rfwp prfwpp – – ROL opr8a ROLA ROLX ROL oprx8,X ROL ,X ROL oprx8,SP Rotate Left through Carry ROR opr8a RORA RORX ROR oprx8,X ROR ,X ROR oprx8,SP Rotate Right through Carry C b7 b0 C b7 b0 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 89 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 7 of 9) Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form Cyc-by-Cyc Details VH I N Z C RSP Reset Stack Pointer (Low Byte) SPL ← $FF (High Byte Not Affected) INH 9C 1 p RTI Return from Interrupt SP ← (SP) + $0001; SP ← (SP) + $0001; SP ← (SP) + $0001; SP ← (SP) + $0001; SP ← (SP) + $0001; INH 80 9 uuuuufppp RTS Return from Subroutine SP ← SP + $0001; Pull (PCH) SP ← SP + $0001; Pull (PCL) INH 81 5 ufppp Subtract with Carry A ← (A) – (M) – (C) IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 A2 B2 C2 D2 E2 F2 9E D2 9E E2 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp SBC SBC SBC SBC SBC SBC SBC SBC #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP Pull (CCR) Pull (A) Pull (X) Pull (PCH) Pull (PCL) ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff Affect on CCR –– – – – – –– – – – – – – SEC Set Carry Bit (C ← 1) INH 99 1 p –– – – – 1 SEI Set Interrupt Mask Bit (I ← 1) INH 9B 1 p –– 1 – – – Store Accumulator in Memory M ← (A) DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 B7 C7 D7 E7 F7 9E D7 9E E7 wpp pwpp pwpp wpp wp ppwpp pwpp 0– – – ee ff ff 3 4 4 3 2 5 4 35 dd 96 hh ll 9E FF ff 4 5 5 wwpp pwwpp pwwpp 0– – – 2 fp... –– 0 – – – 3 4 4 3 2 5 4 wpp pwpp pwpp wpp wp ppwpp pwpp 0– – STA STA STA STA STA STA STA opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP STHX opr8a STHX opr16a STHX oprx8,SP Store H:X (Index Reg.) (M:M + $0001) ← (H:X) DIR EXT SP1 STOP Enable Interrupts: Stop Processing Refer to MCU Documentation I bit ← 0; Stop Processing INH 8E Store X (Low 8 Bits of Index Register) in Memory M ← (X) DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 BF CF DF EF FF 9E DF 9E EF STX STX STX STX STX STX STX opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP dd hh ll ee ff ff dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff – MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 90 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 8 of 9) Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form 83 11 sssssvvfppp INH 84 1 p Transfer Accumulator to X (Index Register Low) X ← (A) INH 97 1 p –– – – – – Transfer CCR to Accumulator A ← (CCR) INH 85 1 p –– – – – – DIR INH INH IX1 IX SP1 3D dd 4D 5D 6D ff 7D 9E 6D ff 4 1 1 4 3 5 rfpp p p rfpp rfp prfpp 0– – SWI Software Interrupt PC ← (PC) + $0001 Push (PCL); SP ← (SP) – $0001 Push (PCH); SP ← (SP) – $0001 Push (X); SP ← (SP) – $0001 Push (A); SP ← (SP) – $0001 Push (CCR); SP ← (SP) – $0001 I ← 1; PCH ← Interrupt Vector High Byte PCL ← Interrupt Vector Low Byte INH TAP Transfer Accumulator to CCR CCR ← (A) TAX TPA TST opr8a TSTA TSTX TST oprx8,X TST ,X TST oprx8,SP VH I N Z C pp rpp prpp prpp rpp rfp pprpp prpp A0 B0 C0 D0 E0 F0 9E D0 9E E0 #opr8i opr8a opr16a oprx16,X oprx8,X ,X oprx16,SP oprx8,SP Affect on CCR 2 3 4 4 3 3 5 4 IMM DIR EXT IX2 IX1 IX SP2 SP1 SUB SUB SUB SUB SUB SUB SUB SUB Cyc-by-Cyc Details Subtract A ← (A) – (M) Test for Negative or Zero (M) – $00 (A) – $00 (X) – $00 (M) – $00 (M) – $00 (M) – $00 ii dd hh ll ee ff ff ee ff ff – – –– 1 – – – – TSX Transfer SP to Index Reg. H:X ← (SP) + $0001 INH 95 2 fp –– – – – – TXA Transfer X (Index Reg. Low) to Accumulator A ← (X) INH 9F 1 p –– – – – – MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 91 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-2. Instruction Set Summary (Sheet 9 of 9) Object Code Cycles Operation Address Mode Source Form Cyc-by-Cyc Details Affect on CCR VH I N Z C TXS Transfer Index Reg. to SP SP ← (H:X) – $0001 INH 94 2 fp –– – – – – WAIT Enable Interrupts; Wait for Interrupt I bit ← 0; Halt CPU INH 8F 2+ fp... –– 0 – – – Source Form: Everything in the source forms columns, except expressions in italic characters, is literal information which must appear in the assembly source file exactly as shown. The initial 3- to 5-letter mnemonic and the characters (# , ( ) and +) are always a literal characters. n Any label or expression that evaluates to a single integer in the range 0-7. opr8i Any label or expression that evaluates to an 8-bit immediate value. opr16i Any label or expression that evaluates to a 16-bit immediate value. opr8a Any label or expression that evaluates to an 8-bit direct-page address ($00xx). opr16a Any label or expression that evaluates to a 16-bit address. oprx8 Any label or expression that evaluates to an unsigned 8-bit value, used for indexed addressing. oprx16 Any label or expression that evaluates to a 16-bit value, used for indexed addressing. rel Any label or expression that refers to an address that is within –128 to +127 locations from the start of the next instruction. Operation Symbols: A Accumulator CCR Condition code register H Index register high byte M Memory location n Any bit opr Operand (one or two bytes) PC Program counter PCH Program counter high byte PCL Program counter low byte rel Relative program counter offset byte SP Stack pointer SPL Stack pointer low byte X Index register low byte & Logical AND | Logical OR ⊕ Logical EXCLUSIVE OR () Contents of + Add – Subtract, Negation (two’s complement) × Multiply ÷ Divide # Immediate value ← Loaded with : Concatenated with Addressing Modes: DIR Direct addressing mode EXT Extended addressing mode IMM Immediate addressing mode INH Inherent addressing mode IX Indexed, no offset addressing mode IX1 Indexed, 8-bit offset addressing mode IX2 Indexed, 16-bit offset addressing mode IX+ Indexed, no offset, post increment addressing mode IX1+ Indexed, 8-bit offset, post increment addressing mode REL Relative addressing mode SP1 Stack pointer, 8-bit offset addressing mode SP2 Stack pointer 16-bit offset addressing mode CCR Bits: V Overflow bit H Half-carry bit I Interrupt mask N Negative bit Z Zero bit C Carry/borrow bit CCR Effects: Set or cleared – Not affected U Undefined Cycle-by-Cycle Codes: f Free cycle. This indicates a cycle where the CPU does not require use of the system buses. An f cycle is always one cycle of the system bus clock and is always a read cycle. p Progryam fetch; read from next consecutive location in program memory r Read 8-bit operand s Push (write) one byte onto stack u Pop (read) one byte from stack v Read vector from $FFxx (high byte first) w Write 8-bit operand MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 92 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-3. Opcode Map (Sheet 1 of 2) Bit-Manipulation Branch 00 5 10 5 20 3 30 BRSET0 3 01 BRCLR0 3 02 BRSET2 3 05 BRSET3 3 07 BRCLR4 3 0A BRSET5 3 0B BRSET6 3 0D BRCLR6 3 0E BRSET7 3 0F BRCLR7 3 INH IMM DIR EXT DD IX+D DIR 2 5 2F Inherent Immediate Direct Extended DIR to DIR IX+ to DIR DBNZ INC REL 2 3 3D TST REL 2 3 3E BIL BIH CLR REL 2 REL IX IX1 IX2 IMD DIX+ DIR 1 ROL INH 2 1 6A Relative Indexed, No Offset Indexed, 8-Bit Offset Indexed, 16-Bit Offset IMM to DIR DIR to IX+ INH 2 4 6B DBNZ DBNZ INC IX1 1 4 7D CLRX IX1 1 CLR ADD INH 2 1 Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset Indexed, No Offset with Post Increment Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with Post Increment BSR Page 2 WAIT INH 1 2 5 BD ADD DIR 3 3 CC LDX 2 1 AF TXA INH 2 LDX IMM 2 2 BF AIX DIR 3 Opcode in Hexadecimal F0 Number of Bytes 1 EXT 3 4 DF STX EXT 3 EOR ADC IX2 2 STA IX 3 EOR IX 3 ADC IX1 1 3 FA ORA IX 3 ORA IX1 1 3 FB ADD JSR LDX IX1 1 3 FF IX 5 JSR IX1 1 3 FE IX1 1 IX 3 JMP IX1 1 5 FD STX IX 3 ADD IX1 1 3 FC JMP IX2 2 4 EF STX IX 2 IX1 1 3 F9 IX2 2 4 EE LDX IX 3 LDA IX1 1 3 F8 IX2 2 6 ED JSR EXT 3 4 DE LDX DIR 3 3 CF STX IMM 2 JSR DIR 3 3 CE BIT STA IX2 2 4 EC JMP EXT 3 6 DD IX 3 IX1 1 3 F7 IX2 2 4 EB ADD EXT 3 4 DC JMP DIR 3 5 CD JSR REL 2 2 BE EXT 3 4 DB AND LDA IX2 2 4 EA ORA IX 3 IX1 1 3 F6 IX2 2 4 E9 ADC CPX BIT IX2 2 4 E8 EOR IX 3 IX1 1 3 F5 IX2 2 4 E7 EXT 3 4 DA ORA JMP INH 2 AE INH 2+ 9F ADC DIR 3 3 CB ADD IMM 2 BC INH 1 AD NOP IX 1 IMM 2 2 BB AND LDA EXT 3 4 D9 IX 3 SBC IX1 1 3 F4 STA EOR DIR 3 3 CA ORA RSP 1 2+ 9E STOP ADC CPX IX2 2 4 E6 EXT 3 4 D8 CMP IX1 1 3 F3 BIT STA DIR 3 3 C9 IMM 2 2 BA ORA SEI INH 1 9D IX 5 8E MOV ADC INH 2 1 AB INH 1 1 9C CLRH IX 1 3 IMD 2 IX+D 1 5 7F 4 8F CLR INH 2 INH 1 2 9B EOR SBC IX2 2 4 E5 EXT 3 4 D7 DIR 3 3 C8 IMM 2 2 B9 INH 2 1 AA CLI TST IX1 1 4 7E MOV SEC INH 1 3 9A PSHH IX 1 4 8C EOR INH 2 1 A9 PULH IX 1 6 8B IX1 2 5 7C TST INH 2 5 6E IX1+ DEC INC INH 2 1 6D PSHX IX 1 4 8A IX1 1 7 7B INH 3 1 6C SP1 SP2 IX+ ROL CLC INH 1 2 99 AND IX 3 IX1 1 3 F2 IX2 2 4 E4 EXT 3 4 D6 LDA STA IMM 2 2 B8 CPX EXT 3 4 D5 DIR 3 3 C7 CMP IX2 2 4 E3 BIT LDA AIS INH 2 1 A8 AND DIR 3 3 C6 IMM 2 2 B7 TAX INH 1 3 98 PULX IX 1 4 89 IX1 1 5 7A DEC DD 2 DIX+ 3 1 5F 1 6F INH 1 LSL IX1 1 5 79 LDA SBC 3 SUB IX1 1 3 F1 IX2 2 4 E2 EXT 3 4 D4 BIT IMM 2 2 B6 EXT 2 1 A7 CPX DIR 3 3 C5 BIT STHX INH 3 2 97 AND CMP EXT 3 4 D3 DIR 3 3 C4 IMM 2 2 B5 INH 2 5 A6 PSHA IX 1 4 88 LSL INH 2 1 69 MOV CLRA ASR IX1 1 5 78 TSTX INH 1 5 5E MOV EXT 3 5 4F ASR INH 2 1 68 PULA CPX AND TSX INH 1 3 96 SBC 3 F0 SUB IX2 2 4 E1 EXT 3 4 D2 DIR 3 3 C3 IMM 2 2 B4 INH 2 2 A5 TPA IX 1 4 87 CPX TXS CMP SBC SUB EXT 3 4 D1 DIR 3 3 C2 IMM 2 2 B3 REL 2 2 A4 INH 1 1 95 DIR 1 4 86 IX1 1 5 77 INCX INH 1 1 5D TSTA DIR 1 6 4E CPHX REL 3 3 3F INCA DIR 1 4 4D INH 2 1 67 DBNZX INH 2 1 5C CPHX ROR BLE TAP CMP SBC SUB DIR 3 3 C1 IMM 2 2 B2 REL 2 3 A3 INH 2 1 94 IX 1 5 85 IMM 2 5 76 ROR DECX INH 1 4 5B DBNZA DIR 2 5 4C CPHX ROLX INH 1 1 5A DECA DIR 1 7 4B REL 3 3 3C BMS DIR 2 5 2E DIR 2 DEC BMC DIR 2 5 2D ROLA DIR 1 5 4A REL 2 3 3B BMI DIR 2 5 2C BCLR7 DIR 2 ROL LSR CMP BGT SWI SUB IMM 2 2 B1 REL 2 3 A2 INH 2 11 93 IX 1 4 84 IX1 1 3 75 DIR 3 1 66 BGND COM SUB BLT INH 2 5+ 92 Register/Memory 3 C0 4 D0 4 E0 2 B0 REL 2 3 A1 RTS INH 1 4 83 LSR LSLX INH 1 1 59 DAA 3 A0 BGE INH 2 6 91 IX+ 1 1 82 IX1 1 5 74 INH 2 4 65 ASRX INH 1 1 58 LSLA DIR 1 5 49 REL 2 3 3A DIR 2 5 2B BSET7 DIR 2 5 1F LSL BHCS BPL ASRA DIR 1 5 48 REL 2 3 39 DIR 2 5 2A BCLR6 DIR 2 5 1E ASR COM RORX INH 1 1 57 CBEQ INH 1 5 73 INH 2 1 64 LDHX IMM 2 1 56 RORA DIR 1 5 47 BHCC DIR 2 5 29 BSET6 DIR 2 5 1D ROR INH 1 1 63 RTI IX 1 5 81 IX1+ 2 1 72 LSRX INH 1 3 55 NEG NSA COMX INH 1 1 54 LDHX DIR 3 5 46 REL 2 3 38 INH 1 1 53 LSRA DIR 1 4 45 STHX BEQ DIR 2 5 28 BCLR5 DIR 2 5 1C LSR CBEQ Control 9 90 4 80 IX1 1 5 71 IMM 3 6 62 DIV COMA DIR 1 5 44 REL 2 3 37 BSET5 DIR 2 5 1B BRCLR5 3 0C DIR 2 5 27 BCLR4 DIR 2 5 1A COM REL 2 3 36 BNE MUL 5 70 NEG INH 2 4 61 CBEQX IMM 3 5 52 EXT 1 5 43 REL 2 3 35 BCS CBEQA LDHX NEGX INH 1 4 51 DIR 3 5 42 BCC DIR 2 5 26 BSET4 DIR 2 5 19 CBEQ REL 2 3 34 DIR 2 5 25 BCLR3 DIR 2 5 18 BRSET4 3 09 BLS NEGA DIR 1 5 41 REL 3 3 33 DIR 2 5 24 BSET3 DIR 2 5 17 BRCLR3 3 08 DIR 2 5 23 BCLR2 DIR 2 5 16 NEG REL 3 3 32 BHI BSET2 DIR 2 5 15 BRCLR2 3 06 BRN DIR 2 5 22 BCLR1 DIR 2 5 14 5 40 REL 2 3 31 BSET1 DIR 2 5 13 BRCLR1 3 04 BRA DIR 2 5 21 BCLR0 DIR 2 5 12 BRSET1 3 03 BSET0 DIR 2 5 11 Read-Modify-Write 1 50 1 60 IX 3 LDX IX 2 STX IX 3 HCS08 Cycles Instruction Mnemonic IX Addressing Mode SUB MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 93 Chapter 7 Central Processor Unit (S08CPUV2) Table 7-3. Opcode Map (Sheet 2 of 2) Bit-Manipulation Branch Read-Modify-Write 9E60 Control Register/Memory 9ED0 5 9EE0 6 NEG SUB 3 SP1 9E61 6 CBEQ 4 CMP SP1 CMP 4 SP2 3 SP1 9ED2 5 9EE2 4 SBC 9E63 SBC 4 SP2 3 SP1 9ED3 5 9EE3 4 9EF3 6 COM CPX 3 SP1 9E64 6 CPX AND SP1 SP1 AND 4 SP2 3 SP1 9ED5 5 9EE5 4 BIT BIT 6 4 SP2 3 SP1 9ED6 5 9EE6 4 3 SP1 9E67 6 4 SP2 3 SP1 9ED7 5 9EE7 4 9E66 6 CPHX 4 SP2 3 SP1 3 9ED4 5 9EE4 4 LSR 3 4 SUB 4 SP2 3 SP1 9ED1 5 9EE1 4 ROR LDA ASR LDA STA 3 SP1 9E68 6 STA 4 SP2 3 SP1 9ED8 5 9EE8 4 LSL EOR 3 SP1 9E69 6 EOR 4 SP2 3 SP1 9ED9 5 9EE9 4 ROL ADC 3 SP1 9E6A 6 ADC 4 SP2 3 SP1 9EDA 5 9EEA 4 DEC ORA 3 SP1 9E6B 8 ORA 4 SP2 3 SP1 9EDB 5 9EEB 4 DBNZ ADD 4 SP1 9E6C 6 4 ADD SP2 3 SP1 INC 3 SP1 9E6D 5 TST 3 SP1 9EAE 5 9EBE LDHX 2 9E6F IX 4 6 9ECE LDHX 5 9EDE LDHX IX2 3 6 CLR 3 INH IMM DIR EXT DD IX+D Inherent Immediate Direct Extended DIR to DIR IX+ to DIR REL IX IX1 IX2 IMD DIX+ Relative Indexed, No Offset Indexed, 8-Bit Offset Indexed, 16-Bit Offset IMM to DIR DIR to IX+ SP1 SP2 IX+ IX1+ Note: All Sheet 2 Opcodes are Preceded by the Page 2 Prebyte (9E) 5 9EEE LDX 4 9EFE LDX 5 LDHX IX1 4 SP2 3 SP1 3 SP1 9EDF 5 9EEF 4 9EFF 5 STX SP1 4 SP2 3 STX SP1 3 STHX SP1 Stack Pointer, 8-Bit Offset Stack Pointer, 16-Bit Offset Indexed, No Offset with Post Increment Indexed, 1-Byte Offset with Post Increment Prebyte (9E) and Opcode in Hexadecimal 9E60 6 HCS08 Cycles Instruction Mnemonic SP1 Addressing Mode NEG Number of Bytes 3 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 94 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 8 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC10V1) 8.1 Introduction The 10-bit analog-to-digital converter (ADC) is a successive approximation ADC designed for operation within an integrated microcontroller system-on-chip. The ADC module design supports up to 28 separate analog inputs (AD0–AD27). Only four (ADC1P0–ADC1P3) of the possible inputs are implemented on the MC9S08QD4 series MCU. These inputs are selected by the ADCH bits. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 95 Chapter 8 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC10V1) BKGD/MS IRQ HCS08 CORE BDC HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT RTI COP IRQ LVD 4-BIT KEYBOARD INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI) 4 TPM2CH0 1-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) TCLK2 2-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) TPM1CH0 TPM1CH1 TCLK1 USER FLASH 4096 / 2048 BYTES 10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) PORT A CPU PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS PTA3/KBI1P3/TCLK2/ADC1P3 PTA2/KBI1P2/TCLK1/ADC1P2 PTA1/KBI1P1/TPM1CH1/ADC1P1 PTA0/KBI1P0/TPM1CH0/ADC1P0 4 USER RAM 256 / 128 BYTES 16 MHz INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE (ICS) VSS VDD VOLTAGE REGULATOR VDDA VSSA VREFH VREFL NOTES: 1 Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port. 2 Port pins are software configurable for output drive strength. 3 Port pins are software configurable for output slew rate control. 4 IRQ contains a software configurable (IRQPDD) pullup/pulldown device if PTA5 enabled as IRQ pin function (IRQPE = 1). 5 RESET contains integrated pullup device if PTA5 enabled as reset pin function (RSTPE = 1). 6 PTA5 does not contain a clamp diode to VDD and must not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on this pin when internal pullup is enabled may be as low as VDD – 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled to VDD. 7 PTA4 contains integrated pullup device if BKGD enabled (BKGDPE = 1). 8 When pin functions as KBI (KBIPEn = 1) and associated pin is configured to enable the pullup device, KBEDGn can be used to reconfigure the pullup as a pulldown device. Figure 8-1. MC9S08QD4 Series Block Diagram Highlighting ADC Block and Pins 8.1.1 Module Configurations This section provides device-specific information for configuring the ADC on MC9S08QD4 series. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 96 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 8 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC10V1) 8.1.1.1 Channel Assignments The ADC channel assignments for the MC9S08QD4 series devices are shown in Table 8-1. Reserved channels convert to an unknown value. Table 8-1. ADC Channel Assignment 1 2 ADCH Channel Input Pin Control ADCH Channel Input Pin Control 00000 AD0 PTA0/ADC1P0 ADPC0 10000 AD16 VSS N/A 00001 AD1 PTA1/ADC1P1 ADPC1 10001 AD17 VSS N/A 00010 AD2 PTA2/ADC1P2 ADPC2 10010 AD18 VSS N/A 00011 AD3 PTA3/ADC1P3 ADPC3 10011 AD19 VSS N/A 00100 AD4 Vss N/A 10100 AD20 VSS N/A 00101 AD5 Vss N/A 10101 AD21 VSS N/A 00110 AD6 Vss N/A 10110 AD22 Reserved N/A 00111 AD7 Vss N/A 10111 AD23 Reserved N/A 01000 AD8 VSS N/A 11000 AD24 Reserved N/A 01001 AD9 VSS N/A 11001 AD25 Reserved N/A 01010 AD10 VSS N/A 11010 AD26 Temperature Sensor1 N/A 01011 AD11 VSS N/A 11011 AD27 Internal Bandgap2 N/A 01100 AD12 VSS N/A 11100 VREFH VDD N/A 01101 AD13 VSS N/A 11101 VREFH VDD N/A 01110 AD14 VSS N/A 11110 VREFL VSS N/A 01111 AD15 VSS N/A 11111 Module Disabled None N/A For information, see Section 8.1.1.5, “Temperature Sensor.” Requires BGBE =1 in SPMSC1 see Section 5.8.8, “System Power Management Status and Control 1 Register (SPMSC1).” For value of bandgap voltage reference see Appendix A.5, “DC Characteristics.” 8.1.1.2 Alternate Clock The ADC is capable of performing conversions using the MCU bus clock, the bus clock divided by two, or the local asynchronous clock (ADACK) within the module. The alternate clock, ALTCLK, input for the MC9S08QD4 series MCU devices is not implemented. 8.1.1.3 Hardware Trigger The ADC hardware trigger, ADHWT, is output from the real-time interrupt (RTI) counter. The RTI counter can be clocked by either ICSERCLK or a nominal 32 kHz clock source within the RTI block. The period of the RTI is determined by the input clock frequency and the RTIS bits. The RTI counter is a free running counter that generates an overflow at the RTI rate determined by the RTIS bits. When the ADC hardware trigger is enabled, a conversion is initiated upon a RTI counter overflow. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 97 Chapter 8 Analog-to-Digital Converter (ADC10V1) The RTI can be configured to cause a hardware trigger in MCU run, wait, and stop3. 8.1.1.4 Analog Pin Enables The ADC on MC9S08QD4 contains only one analog pin enable register, APCTL1. 8.1.1.5 Temperature Sensor To use the on-chip temperature sensor, the user must perform the following: • Configure ADC for long sample with a maximum of 1 MHz clock • Convert the bandgap voltage reference channel (AD27) — By converting the digital value of the bandgap voltage reference channel using the value of VBG the user can determine VDD. For value of bandgap voltage, see Appendix A.5, “DC Characteristics”. • Convert the temperature sensor channel (AD26) — By using the calculated value of VDD, convert the digital value of AD26 into a voltage, VTEMP Equation 8-1 provides an approximate transfer function of the on-chip temperature sensor for VDD = 3.0V, Temp = 25°C, using the ADC at fADCK = 1.0 MHz and configured for long sample. TempC = 25 – ((VTEMP – 1.3894) / ( 0.0033)) Eqn. 8-1 0.0017 is the uncalibrated voltage versus temperature slope in V/°C. Uncalibrated accuracy of the temperature sensor is approximately ± 12°C, using Equation 8-1. To improve accuracy the user must calibrate the bandgap voltage reference and temperature sensor. Calibrating at 25°C will improve accuracy to ± 4.5°C. Calibration at 3 points, -40°C, 25°C and 105°C will improve accuracy to ± 2.5°C. Once calibration has been completed, the user will need to calculate the slope for both hot and cold. In application code, the user would then calculate the temperature using Equation 8-1 as detailed above and then determine if the temperature is above or below 25°C. Once determined if the temperature is above or below 25°C, the user can recalculate the temperature using the hot or cold slope value obtained during calibration. 8.1.1.6 Low-Power Mode Operation The ADC is capable of running in stop3 mode but requires LVDSE in SPMSC1 to be set. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 98 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 8.1.2 Features Features of the ADC module include: • Linear successive approximation algorithm with 10 bits resolution. • Up to 28 analog inputs. • Output formatted in 10- or 8-bit right-justified format. • Single or continuous conversion (automatic return to idle after single conversion). • Configurable sample time and conversion speed/power. • Conversion complete flag and interrupt. • Input clock selectable from up to four sources. • Operation in wait or stop3 modes for lower noise operation. • Asynchronous clock source for lower noise operation. • Selectable asynchronous hardware conversion trigger. • Automatic compare with interrupt for less-than, or greater-than or equal-to, programmable value. 8.1.3 Block Diagram Figure 8-2 provides a block diagram of the ADC module MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 99 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) ADIV ADLPC MODE ADLSMP ADTRG 2 ADCO ADCH 1 ADCCFG complete COCO ADCSC1 ADICLK Compare true AIEN 3 Async Clock Gen ADACK MCU STOP ADCK ÷2 ALTCLK abort transfer sample initialize ••• AD0 convert Control Sequencer ADHWT Bus Clock Clock Divide AIEN 1 COCO 2 ADVIN Interrupt SAR Converter AD27 VREFH Data Registers Sum VREFL Compare true 3 Compare Value Registers ACFGT Value Compare Logic ADCSC2 Figure 8-2. ADC Block Diagram 8.2 External Signal Description The ADC module supports up to 28 separate analog inputs. It also requires four supply/reference/ground connections. Table 8-2. Signal Properties Name Function AD27–AD0 Analog Channel inputs VREFH High reference voltage VREFL Low reference voltage VDDAD Analog power supply VSSAD Analog ground MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 100 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 8.2.1 Analog Power (VDDAD) The ADC analog portion uses VDDAD as its power connection. In some packages, VDDAD is connected internally to VDD. If externally available, connect the VDDAD pin to the same voltage potential as VDD. External filtering may be necessary to ensure clean VDDAD for good results. 8.2.2 Analog Ground (VSSAD) The ADC analog portion uses VSSAD as its ground connection. In some packages, VSSAD is connected internally to VSS. If externally available, connect the VSSAD pin to the same voltage potential as VSS. 8.2.3 Voltage Reference High (VREFH) VREFH is the high reference voltage for the converter. In some packages, VREFH is connected internally to VDDAD. If externally available, VREFH may be connected to the same potential as VDDAD, or may be driven by an external source that is between the minimum VDDAD spec and the VDDAD potential (VREFH must never exceed VDDAD). 8.2.4 Voltage Reference Low (VREFL) VREFL is the low reference voltage for the converter. In some packages, VREFL is connected internally to VSSAD. If externally available, connect the VREFL pin to the same voltage potential as VSSAD. 8.2.5 Analog Channel Inputs (ADx) The ADC module supports up to 28 separate analog inputs. An input is selected for conversion through the ADCH channel select bits. 8.3 Register Definition These memory mapped registers control and monitor operation of the ADC: • • • • • • 8.3.1 Status and control register, ADCSC1 Status and control register, ADCSC2 Data result registers, ADCRH and ADCRL Compare value registers, ADCCVH and ADCCVL Configuration register, ADCCFG Pin enable registers, APCTL1, APCTL2, APCTL3 Status and Control Register 1 (ADCSC1) This section describes the function of the ADC status and control register (ADCSC1). Writing ADCSC1 aborts the current conversion and initiates a new conversion (if the ADCH bits are equal to a value other than all 1s). MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 101 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 7 R 6 5 4 AIEN ADCO 0 0 3 2 1 0 1 1 COCO ADCH W Reset: 0 1 1 1 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 8-3. Status and Control Register (ADCSC1) Table 8-3. ADCSC1 Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 COCO Conversion Complete Flag — The COCO flag is a read-only bit which is set each time a conversion is completed when the compare function is disabled (ACFE = 0). When the compare function is enabled (ACFE = 1) the COCO flag is set upon completion of a conversion only if the compare result is true. This bit is cleared whenever ADCSC1 is written or whenever ADCRL is read. 0 Conversion not completed 1 Conversion completed 6 AIEN Interrupt Enable — AIEN is used to enable conversion complete interrupts. When COCO becomes set while AIEN is high, an interrupt is asserted. 0 Conversion complete interrupt disabled 1 Conversion complete interrupt enabled 5 ADCO Continuous Conversion Enable — ADCO is used to enable continuous conversions. 0 One conversion following a write to the ADCSC1 when software triggered operation is selected, or one conversion following assertion of ADHWT when hardware triggered operation is selected. 1 Continuous conversions initiated following a write to ADCSC1 when software triggered operation is selected. Continuous conversions are initiated by an ADHWT event when hardware triggered operation is selected. 4:0 ADCH Input Channel Select — The ADCH bits form a 5-bit field which is used to select one of the input channels. The input channels are detailed in Figure 8-4. The successive approximation converter subsystem is turned off when the channel select bits are all set to 1. This feature allows for explicit disabling of the ADC and isolation of the input channel from all sources. Terminating continuous conversions this way will prevent an additional, single conversion from being performed. It is not necessary to set the channel select bits to all 1s to place the ADC in a low-power state when continuous conversions are not enabled because the module automatically enters a low-power state when a conversion completes. Figure 8-4. Input Channel Select ADCH Input Select ADCH Input Select 00000 AD0 10000 AD16 00001 AD1 10001 AD17 00010 AD2 10010 AD18 00011 AD3 10011 AD19 00100 AD4 10100 AD20 00101 AD5 10101 AD21 00110 AD6 10110 AD22 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 102 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) Figure 8-4. Input Channel Select (continued) 8.3.2 ADCH Input Select ADCH Input Select 00111 AD7 10111 AD23 01000 AD8 11000 AD24 01001 AD9 11001 AD25 01010 AD10 11010 AD26 01011 AD11 11011 AD27 01100 AD12 11100 Reserved 01101 AD13 11101 VREFH 01110 AD14 11110 VREFL 01111 AD15 11111 Module disabled Status and Control Register 2 (ADCSC2) The ADCSC2 register is used to control the compare function, conversion trigger and conversion active of the ADC module. 7 R 6 5 4 ADTRG ACFE ACFGT 0 0 0 ADACT 3 2 0 0 0 0 1 0 R1 R1 0 0 W Reset: 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved 1 Bits 1 and 0 are reserved bits that must always be written to 0. Figure 8-5. Status and Control Register 2 (ADCSC2) Table 8-4. ADCSC2 Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 ADACT Conversion Active — ADACT indicates that a conversion is in progress. ADACT is set when a conversion is initiated and cleared when a conversion is completed or aborted. 0 Conversion not in progress 1 Conversion in progress 6 ADTRG Conversion Trigger Select — ADTRG is used to select the type of trigger to be used for initiating a conversion. Two types of trigger are selectable: software trigger and hardware trigger. When software trigger is selected, a conversion is initiated following a write to ADCSC1. When hardware trigger is selected, a conversion is initiated following the assertion of the ADHWT input. 0 Software trigger selected 1 Hardware trigger selected MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 103 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) Table 8-4. ADCSC2 Register Field Descriptions (continued) Field Description 5 ACFE Compare Function Enable — ACFE is used to enable the compare function. 0 Compare function disabled 1 Compare function enabled 4 ACFGT Compare Function Greater Than Enable — ACFGT is used to configure the compare function to trigger when the result of the conversion of the input being monitored is greater than or equal to the compare value. The compare function defaults to triggering when the result of the compare of the input being monitored is less than the compare value. 0 Compare triggers when input is less than compare level 1 Compare triggers when input is greater than or equal to compare level 8.3.3 Data Result High Register (ADCRH) ADCRH contains the upper two bits of the result of a 10-bit conversion. When configured for 8-bit conversions both ADR8 and ADR9 are equal to zero. ADCRH is updated each time a conversion completes except when automatic compare is enabled and the compare condition is not met. In 10-bit MODE, reading ADCRH prevents the ADC from transferring subsequent conversion results into the result registers until ADCRL is read. If ADCRL is not read until after the next conversion is completed, then the intermediate conversion result will be lost. In 8-bit mode there is no interlocking with ADCRL. In the case that the MODE bits are changed, any data in ADCRH becomes invalid. R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 ADR9 ADR8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset: = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 8-6. Data Result High Register (ADCRH) 8.3.4 Data Result Low Register (ADCRL) ADCRL contains the lower eight bits of the result of a 10-bit conversion, and all eight bits of an 8-bit conversion. This register is updated each time a conversion completes except when automatic compare is enabled and the compare condition is not met. In 10-bit mode, reading ADCRH prevents the ADC from transferring subsequent conversion results into the result registers until ADCRL is read. If ADCRL is not read until the after next conversion is completed, then the intermediate conversion results will be lost. In 8-bit mode, there is no interlocking with ADCRH. In the case that the MODE bits are changed, any data in ADCRL becomes invalid. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 104 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADR7 ADR6 ADR5 ADR4 ADR3 ADR2 ADR1 ADR0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset: = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 8-7. Data Result Low Register (ADCRL) 8.3.5 Compare Value High Register (ADCCVH) This register holds the upper two bits of the 10-bit compare value. These bits are compared to the upper two bits of the result following a conversion in 10-bit mode when the compare function is enabled.In 8-bit operation, ADCCVH is not used during compare. R 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 3 2 1 0 ADCV9 ADCV8 0 0 W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 8-8. Compare Value High Register (ADCCVH) 8.3.6 Compare Value Low Register (ADCCVL) This register holds the lower 8 bits of the 10-bit compare value, or all 8 bits of the 8-bit compare value. Bits ADCV7:ADCV0 are compared to the lower 8 bits of the result following a conversion in either 10-bit or 8-bit mode. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADCV7 ADCV6 ADCV5 ADCV4 ADCV3 ADCV2 ADCV1 ADCV0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset: Figure 8-9. Compare Value Low Register(ADCCVL) 8.3.7 Configuration Register (ADCCFG) ADCCFG is used to select the mode of operation, clock source, clock divide, and configure for low power or long sample time. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 105 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R ADLPC ADIV ADLSMP MODE ADICLK W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 8-10. Configuration Register (ADCCFG) Table 8-5. ADCCFG Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 ADLPC Low Power Configuration — ADLPC controls the speed and power configuration of the successive approximation converter. This is used to optimize power consumption when higher sample rates are not required. 0 High speed configuration 1 Low power configuration: {FC31}The power is reduced at the expense of maximum clock speed. 6:5 ADIV Clock Divide Select — ADIV select the divide ratio used by the ADC to generate the internal clock ADCK. Table 8-6 shows the available clock configurations. 4 ADLSMP Long Sample Time Configuration — ADLSMP selects between long and short sample time. This adjusts the sample period to allow higher impedance inputs to be accurately sampled or to maximize conversion speed for lower impedance inputs. Longer sample times can also be used to lower overall power consumption when continuous conversions are enabled if high conversion rates are not required. 0 Short sample time 1 Long sample time 3:2 MODE Conversion Mode Selection — MODE bits are used to select between 10- or 8-bit operation. See Table 8-7. 1:0 ADICLK Input Clock Select — ADICLK bits select the input clock source to generate the internal clock ADCK. See Table 8-8. Table 8-6. Clock Divide Select ADIV Divide Ratio Clock Rate 00 1 Input clock 01 2 Input clock ÷ 2 10 4 Input clock ÷ 4 11 8 Input clock ÷ 8 Table 8-7. Conversion Modes MODE Mode Description 00 8-bit conversion (N=8) 01 Reserved 10 10-bit conversion (N=10) 11 Reserved MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 106 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) Table 8-8. Input Clock Select ADICLK Selected Clock Source 00 8.3.8 Bus clock 01 Bus clock divided by 2 10 Alternate clock (ALTCLK) 11 Asynchronous clock (ADACK) Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1) The pin control registers are used to disable the I/O port control of MCU pins used as analog inputs. APCTL1 is used to control the pins associated with channels 0–7 of the ADC module. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADPC7 ADPC6 ADPC5 ADPC4 ADPC3 ADPC2 ADPC1 ADPC0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset: Figure 8-11. Pin Control 1 Register (APCTL1) Table 8-9. APCTL1 Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 ADPC7 ADC Pin Control 7 — ADPC7 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD7. 0 AD7 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD7 pin I/O control disabled 6 ADPC6 ADC Pin Control 6 — ADPC6 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD6. 0 AD6 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD6 pin I/O control disabled 5 ADPC5 ADC Pin Control 5 — ADPC5 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD5. 0 AD5 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD5 pin I/O control disabled 4 ADPC4 ADC Pin Control 4 — ADPC4 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD4. 0 AD4 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD4 pin I/O control disabled 3 ADPC3 ADC Pin Control 3 — ADPC3 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD3. 0 AD3 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD3 pin I/O control disabled 2 ADPC2 ADC Pin Control 2 — ADPC2 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD2. 0 AD2 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD2 pin I/O control disabled MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 107 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) Table 8-9. APCTL1 Register Field Descriptions (continued) Field Description 1 ADPC1 ADC Pin Control 1 — ADPC1 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD1. 0 AD1 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD1 pin I/O control disabled 0 ADPC0 ADC Pin Control 0 — ADPC0 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD0. 0 AD0 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD0 pin I/O control disabled 8.3.9 Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2) APCTL2 is used to control channels 8–15 of the ADC module. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADPC15 ADPC14 ADPC13 ADPC12 ADPC11 ADPC10 ADPC9 ADPC8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset: Figure 8-12. Pin Control 2 Register (APCTL2) Table 8-10. APCTL2 Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 ADPC15 ADC Pin Control 15 — ADPC15 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD15. 0 AD15 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD15 pin I/O control disabled 6 ADPC14 ADC Pin Control 14 — ADPC14 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD14. 0 AD14 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD14 pin I/O control disabled 5 ADPC13 ADC Pin Control 13 — ADPC13 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD13. 0 AD13 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD13 pin I/O control disabled 4 ADPC12 ADC Pin Control 12 — ADPC12 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD12. 0 AD12 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD12 pin I/O control disabled 3 ADPC11 ADC Pin Control 11 — ADPC11 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD11. 0 AD11 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD11 pin I/O control disabled 2 ADPC10 ADC Pin Control 10 — ADPC10 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD10. 0 AD10 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD10 pin I/O control disabled MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 108 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) Table 8-10. APCTL2 Register Field Descriptions (continued) Field Description 1 ADPC9 ADC Pin Control 9 — ADPC9 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD9. 0 AD9 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD9 pin I/O control disabled 0 ADPC8 ADC Pin Control 8 — ADPC8 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD8. 0 AD8 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD8 pin I/O control disabled 8.3.10 Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3) APCTL3 is used to control channels 16–23 of the ADC module. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 ADPC23 ADPC22 ADPC21 ADPC20 ADPC19 ADPC18 ADPC17 ADPC16 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset: Figure 8-13. Pin Control 3 Register (APCTL3) Table 8-11. APCTL3 Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 ADPC23 ADC Pin Control 23 — ADPC23 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD23. 0 AD23 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD23 pin I/O control disabled 6 ADPC22 ADC Pin Control 22 — ADPC22 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD22. 0 AD22 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD22 pin I/O control disabled 5 ADPC21 ADC Pin Control 21 — ADPC21 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD21. 0 AD21 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD21 pin I/O control disabled 4 ADPC20 ADC Pin Control 20 — ADPC20 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD20. 0 AD20 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD20 pin I/O control disabled 3 ADPC19 ADC Pin Control 19 — ADPC19 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD19. 0 AD19 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD19 pin I/O control disabled 2 ADPC18 ADC Pin Control 18 — ADPC18 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD18. 0 AD18 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD18 pin I/O control disabled MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 109 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) Table 8-11. APCTL3 Register Field Descriptions (continued) Field Description 1 ADPC17 ADC Pin Control 17 — ADPC17 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD17. 0 AD17 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD17 pin I/O control disabled 0 ADPC16 ADC Pin Control 16 — ADPC16 is used to control the pin associated with channel AD16. 0 AD16 pin I/O control enabled 1 AD16 pin I/O control disabled 8.4 Functional Description The ADC module is disabled during reset or when the ADCH bits are all high. The module is idle when a conversion has completed and another conversion has not been initiated. When idle, the module is in its lowest power state. The ADC can perform an analog-to-digital conversion on any of the software selectable channels. The selected channel voltage is converted by a successive approximation algorithm into an 11-bit digital result. In 8-bit mode, the selected channel voltage is converted by a successive approximation algorithm into a 9-bit digital result. When the conversion is completed, the result is placed in the data registers (ADCRH and ADCRL).In 10-bit mode, the result is rounded to 10 bits and placed in ADCRH and ADCRL. In 8-bit mode, the result is rounded to 8 bits and placed in ADCRL. The conversion complete flag (COCO) is then set and an interrupt is generated if the conversion complete interrupt has been enabled (AIEN = 1). The ADC module has the capability of automatically comparing the result of a conversion with the contents of its compare registers. The compare function is enabled by setting the ACFE bit and operates in conjunction with any of the conversion modes and configurations. 8.4.1 Clock Select and Divide Control One of four clock sources can be selected as the clock source for the ADC module. This clock source is then divided by a configurable value to generate the input clock to the converter (ADCK). The clock is selected from one of the following sources by means of the ADICLK bits. • • • • The bus clock, which is equal to the frequency at which software is executed. This is the default selection following reset. The bus clock divided by 2. For higher bus clock rates, this allows a maximum divide by 16 of the bus clock. ALTCLK, as defined for this MCU (See module section introduction). The asynchronous clock (ADACK) – This clock is generated from a clock source within the ADC module. When selected as the clock source this clock remains active while the MCU is in wait or stop3 mode and allows conversions in these modes for lower noise operation. Whichever clock is selected, its frequency must fall within the specified frequency range for ADCK. If the available clocks are too slow, the ADC will not perform according to specifications. If the available clocks MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 110 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) are too fast, then the clock must be divided to the appropriate frequency. This divider is specified by the ADIV bits and can be divide-by 1, 2, 4, or 8. 8.4.2 Input Select and Pin Control The pin control registers (APCTL3, APCTL2, and APCTL1) are used to disable the I/O port control of the pins used as analog inputs.When a pin control register bit is set, the following conditions are forced for the associated MCU pin: • The output buffer is forced to its high impedance state. • The input buffer is disabled. A read of the I/O port returns a zero for any pin with its input buffer disabled. • The pullup is disabled. 8.4.3 Hardware Trigger The ADC module has a selectable asynchronous hardware conversion trigger, ADHWT, that is enabled when the ADTRG bit is set. This source is not available on all MCUs. Consult the module introduction for information on the ADHWT source specific to this MCU. When ADHWT source is available and hardware trigger is enabled (ADTRG=1), a conversion is initiated on the rising edge of ADHWT. If a conversion is in progress when a rising edge occurs, the rising edge is ignored. In continuous convert configuration, only the initial rising edge to launch continuous conversions is observed. The hardware trigger function operates in conjunction with any of the conversion modes and configurations. 8.4.4 Conversion Control Conversions can be performed in either 10-bit mode or 8-bit mode as determined by the MODE bits. Conversions can be initiated by either a software or hardware trigger. In addition, the ADC module can be configured for low power operation, long sample time, continuous conversion, and automatic compare of the conversion result to a software determined compare value. 8.4.4.1 Initiating Conversions A conversion is initiated: • Following a write to ADCSC1 (with ADCH bits not all 1s) if software triggered operation is selected. • Following a hardware trigger (ADHWT) event if hardware triggered operation is selected. • Following the transfer of the result to the data registers when continuous conversion is enabled. If continuous conversions are enabled a new conversion is automatically initiated after the completion of the current conversion. In software triggered operation, continuous conversions begin after ADCSC1 is written and continue until aborted. In hardware triggered operation, continuous conversions begin after a hardware trigger event and continue until aborted. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 111 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 8.4.4.2 Completing Conversions A conversion is completed when the result of the conversion is transferred into the data result registers, ADCRH and ADCRL. This is indicated by the setting of COCO. An interrupt is generated if AIEN is high at the time that COCO is set. A blocking mechanism prevents a new result from overwriting previous data in ADCRH and ADCRL if the previous data is in the process of being read while in 10-bit MODE (the ADCRH register has been read but the ADCRL register has not). When blocking is active, the data transfer is blocked, COCO is not set, and the new result is lost. In the case of single conversions with the compare function enabled and the compare condition false, blocking has no effect and ADC operation is terminated. In all other cases of operation, when a data transfer is blocked, another conversion is initiated regardless of the state of ADCO (single or continuous conversions enabled). If single conversions are enabled, the blocking mechanism could result in several discarded conversions and excess power consumption. To avoid this issue, the data registers must not be read after initiating a single conversion until the conversion completes. 8.4.4.3 Aborting Conversions Any conversion in progress will be aborted when: • A write to ADCSC1 occurs (the current conversion will be aborted and a new conversion will be initiated, if ADCH are not all 1s). • A write to ADCSC2, ADCCFG, ADCCVH, or ADCCVL occurs. This indicates a mode of operation change has occurred and the current conversion is therefore invalid. • The MCU is reset. • The MCU enters stop mode with ADACK not enabled. When a conversion is aborted, the contents of the data registers, ADCRH and ADCRL, are not altered but continue to be the values transferred after the completion of the last successful conversion. In the case that the conversion was aborted by a reset, ADCRH and ADCRL return to their reset states. 8.4.4.4 Power Control The ADC module remains in its idle state until a conversion is initiated. If ADACK is selected as the conversion clock source, the ADACK clock generator is also enabled. Power consumption when active can be reduced by setting ADLPC. This results in a lower maximum value for fADCK (see the electrical specifications). 8.4.4.5 Total Conversion Time The total conversion time depends on the sample time (as determined by ADLSMP), the MCU bus frequency, the conversion mode (8-bit or 10-bit), and the frequency of the conversion clock (fADCK). After the module becomes active, sampling of the input begins. ADLSMP is used to select between short and long sample times.When sampling is complete, the converter is isolated from the input channel and a successive approximation algorithm is performed to determine the digital value of the analog signal. The MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 112 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) result of the conversion is transferred to ADCRH and ADCRL upon completion of the conversion algorithm. If the bus frequency is less than the fADCK frequency, precise sample time for continuous conversions cannot be guaranteed when short sample is enabled (ADLSMP=0). If the bus frequency is less than 1/11th of the fADCK frequency, precise sample time for continuous conversions cannot be guaranteed when long sample is enabled (ADLSMP=1). The maximum total conversion time for different conditions is summarized in Table 8-12. Table 8-12. Total Conversion Time vs. Control Conditions Conversion Type ADICLK ADLSMP Max Total Conversion Time Single or first continuous 8-bit 0x, 10 0 20 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles Single or first continuous 10-bit 0x, 10 0 23 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles Single or first continuous 8-bit 0x, 10 1 40 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles Single or first continuous 10-bit 0x, 10 1 43 ADCK cycles + 5 bus clock cycles Single or first continuous 8-bit 11 0 5 μs + 20 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles Single or first continuous 10-bit 11 0 5 μs + 23 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles Single or first continuous 8-bit 11 1 5 μs + 40 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles Single or first continuous 10-bit 11 1 5 μs + 43 ADCK + 5 bus clock cycles Subsequent continuous 8-bit; fBUS > fADCK xx 0 17 ADCK cycles Subsequent continuous 10-bit; fBUS > fADCK xx 0 20 ADCK cycles Subsequent continuous 8-bit; fBUS > fADCK/11 xx 1 37 ADCK cycles Subsequent continuous 10-bit; fBUS > fADCK/11 xx 1 40 ADCK cycles The maximum total conversion time is determined by the clock source chosen and the divide ratio selected. The clock source is selectable by the ADICLK bits, and the divide ratio is specified by the ADIV bits. For example, in 10-bit mode, with the bus clock selected as the input clock source, the input clock divide-by-1 ratio selected, and a bus frequency of 8 MHz, then the conversion time for a single conversion is: Conversion time = 23 ADCK cyc 8 MHz/1 + 5 bus cyc 8 MHz = 3.5 μs Number of bus cycles = 3.5 μs x 8 MHz = 28 cycles NOTE The ADCK frequency must be between fADCK minimum and fADCK maximum to meet ADC specifications. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 113 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 8.4.5 Automatic Compare Function The compare function can be configured to check for either an upper limit or lower limit. After the input is sampled and converted, the result is added to the two’s complement of the compare value (ADCCVH and ADCCVL). When comparing to an upper limit (ACFGT = 1), if the result is greater-than or equal-to the compare value, COCO is set. When comparing to a lower limit (ACFGT = 0), if the result is less than the compare value, COCO is set. The value generated by the addition of the conversion result and the two’s complement of the compare value is transferred to ADCRH and ADCRL. Upon completion of a conversion while the compare function is enabled, if the compare condition is not true, COCO is not set and no data is transferred to the result registers. An ADC interrupt is generated upon the setting of COCO if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1). NOTE The compare function can be used to monitor the voltage on a channel while the MCU is in either wait or stop3 mode. The ADC interrupt will wake the MCU when the compare condition is met. 8.4.6 MCU Wait Mode Operation The WAIT instruction puts the MCU in a lower power-consumption standby mode from which recovery is very fast because the clock sources remain active. If a conversion is in progress when the MCU enters wait mode, it continues until completion. Conversions can be initiated while the MCU is in wait mode by means of the hardware trigger or if continuous conversions are enabled. The bus clock, bus clock divided by two, and ADACK are available as conversion clock sources while in wait mode. The use of ALTCLK as the conversion clock source in wait is dependent on the definition of ALTCLK for this MCU. Consult the module introduction for information on ALTCLK specific to this MCU. A conversion complete event sets the COCO and generates an ADC interrupt to wake the MCU from wait mode if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1). 8.4.7 MCU Stop3 Mode Operation The STOP instruction is used to put the MCU in a low power-consumption standby mode during which most or all clock sources on the MCU are disabled. 8.4.7.1 Stop3 Mode With ADACK Disabled If the asynchronous clock, ADACK, is not selected as the conversion clock, executing a STOP instruction aborts the current conversion and places the ADC in its idle state. The contents of ADCRH and ADCRL are unaffected by stop3 mode.After exiting from stop3 mode, a software or hardware trigger is required to resume conversions. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 114 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 8.4.7.2 Stop3 Mode With ADACK Enabled If ADACK is selected as the conversion clock, the ADC continues operation during stop3 mode. For guaranteed ADC operation, the MCU’s voltage regulator must remain active during stop3 mode. Consult the module introduction for configuration information for this MCU. If a conversion is in progress when the MCU enters stop3 mode, it continues until completion. Conversions can be initiated while the MCU is in stop3 mode by means of the hardware trigger or if continuous conversions are enabled. A conversion complete event sets the COCO and generates an ADC interrupt to wake the MCU from stop3 mode if the ADC interrupt is enabled (AIEN = 1). NOTE It is possible for the ADC module to wake the system from low power stop and cause the MCU to begin consuming run-level currents without generating a system level interrupt. To prevent this scenario, software must ensure that the data transfer blocking mechanism (discussed in Section 8.4.4.2, “Completing Conversions,”) is cleared when entering stop3 and continuing ADC conversions. 8.4.8 MCU Stop1 and Stop2 Mode Operation The ADC module is automatically disabled when the MCU enters either stop1 or stop2 mode. All module registers contain their reset values following exit from stop1 or stop2. Therefore the module must be re-enabled and re-configured following exit from stop1 or stop2. 8.5 Initialization Information This section gives an example which provides some basic direction on how a user would initialize and configure the ADC module. The user has the flexibility of choosing between configuring the module for 8-bit or 10-bit resolution, single or continuous conversion, and a polled or interrupt approach, among many other options. Refer to Table 8-6, Table 8-7, and Table 8-8 for information used in this example. NOTE Hexadecimal values designated by a preceding 0x, binary values designated by a preceding %, and decimal values have no preceding character. 8.5.1 8.5.1.1 ADC Module Initialization Example Initialization Sequence Before the ADC module can be used to complete conversions, an initialization procedure must be performed. A typical sequence is as follows: 1. Update the configuration register (ADCCFG) to select the input clock source and the divide ratio used to generate the internal clock, ADCK. This register is also used for selecting sample time and low-power configuration. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 115 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 2. Update status and control register 2 (ADCSC2) to select the conversion trigger (hardware or software) and compare function options, if enabled. 3. Update status and control register 1 (ADCSC1) to select whether conversions will be continuous or completed only once, and to enable or disable conversion complete interrupts. The input channel on which conversions will be performed is also selected here. 8.5.1.2 Pseudo — Code Example In this example, the ADC module will be set up with interrupts enabled to perform a single 10-bit conversion at low power with a long sample time on input channel 1, where the internal ADCK clock will be derived from the bus clock divided by 1. ADCCFG = 0x98 (%10011000) Bit 7 ADLPC 1 Configures for low power (lowers maximum clock speed) Bit 6:5 ADIV 00 Sets the ADCK to the input clock ÷ 1 Bit 4 ADLSMP 1 Configures for long sample time Bit 3:2 MODE 10 Sets mode at 10-bit conversions Bit 1:0 ADICLK 00 Selects bus clock as input clock source ADCSC2 = 0x00 (%00000000) Bit 7 ADACT 0 Bit 6 ADTRG 0 Bit 5 ACFE 0 Bit 4 ACFGT 0 Bit 3:2 00 Bit 1:0 00 Flag indicates if a conversion is in progress Software trigger selected Compare function disabled Not used in this example Unimplemented or reserved, always reads zero Reserved for Freescale’s internal use; always write zero ADCSC1 = 0x41 (%01000001) Bit 7 COCO 0 Bit 6 AIEN 1 Bit 5 ADCO 0 Bit 4:0 ADCH 00001 Read-only flag which is set when a conversion completes Conversion complete interrupt enabled One conversion only (continuous conversions disabled) Input channel 1 selected as ADC input channel ADCRH/L = 0xxx Holds results of conversion. Read high byte (ADCRH) before low byte (ADCRL) so that conversion data cannot be overwritten with data from the next conversion. ADCCVH/L = 0xxx Holds compare value when compare function enabled APCTL1=0x02 AD1 pin I/O control disabled. All other AD pins remain general purpose I/O pins APCTL2=0x00 All other AD pins remain general purpose I/O pins MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 116 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) RESET INITIALIZE ADC ADCCFG = $98 ADCSC2 = $00 ADCSC1 = $41 CHECK COCO=1? NO YES READ ADCRH THEN ADCRL TO CLEAR COCO BIT CONTINUE Figure 8-14. Initialization Flowchart for Example 8.6 Application Information This section contains information for using the ADC module in applications. The ADC has been designed to be integrated into a microcontroller for use in embedded control applications requiring an A/D converter. 8.6.1 External Pins and Routing The following sections discuss the external pins associated with the ADC module and how they must be used for best results. 8.6.1.1 Analog Supply Pins The ADC module has analog power and ground supplies (VDDAD and VSSAD) which are available as separate pins on some devices. On other devices, VSSAD is shared on the same pin as the MCU digital VSS, and on others, both VSSAD and VDDAD are shared with the MCU digital supply pins. In these cases, there are separate pads for the analog supplies which are bonded to the same pin as the corresponding digital supply so that some degree of isolation between the supplies is maintained. When available on a separate pin, both VDDAD and VSSAD must be connected to the same voltage potential as their corresponding MCU digital supply (VDD and VSS) and must be routed carefully for maximum noise immunity and bypass capacitors placed as near as possible to the package. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 117 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) In cases where separate power supplies are used for analog and digital power, the ground connection between these supplies must be at the VSSAD pin. This must be the only ground connection between these supplies if possible. The VSSAD pin makes a good single point ground location. 8.6.1.2 Analog Reference Pins In addition to the analog supplies, the ADC module has connections for two reference voltage inputs. The high reference is VREFH, which may be shared on the same pin as VDDAD on some devices. The low reference is VREFL, which may be shared on the same pin as VSSAD on some devices. When available on a separate pin, VREFH may be connected to the same potential as VDDAD, or may be driven by an external source that is between the minimum VDDAD spec and the VDDAD potential (VREFH must never exceed VDDAD). When available on a separate pin, VREFL must be connected to the same voltage potential as VSSAD. Both VREFH and VREFL must be routed carefully for maximum noise immunity and bypass capacitors placed as near as possible to the package. AC current in the form of current spikes required to supply charge to the capacitor array at each successive approximation step is drawn through the VREFH and VREFL loop. The best external component to meet this current demand is a 0.1 μF capacitor with good high frequency characteristics. This capacitor is connected between VREFH and VREFL and must be placed as near as possible to the package pins. Resistance in the path is not recommended because the current will cause a voltage drop which could result in conversion errors. Inductance in this path must be minimum (parasitic only). 8.6.1.3 Analog Input Pins The external analog inputs are typically shared with digital I/O pins on MCU devices. The pin I/O control is disabled by setting the appropriate control bit in one of the pin control registers. Conversions can be performed on inputs without the associated pin control register bit set. It is recommended that the pin control register bit always be set when using a pin as an analog input. This avoids problems with contention because the output buffer will be in its high impedance state and the pullup is disabled. Also, the input buffer draws dc current when its input is not at either VDD or VSS. Setting the pin control register bits for all pins used as analog inputs must be done to achieve lowest operating current. Empirical data shows that capacitors on the analog inputs improve performance in the presence of noise or when the source impedance is high. Use of 0.01 μF capacitors with good high-frequency characteristics is sufficient. These capacitors are not necessary in all cases, but when used they must be placed as near as possible to the package pins and be referenced to VSSA. For proper conversion, the input voltage must fall between VREFH and VREFL. If the input is equal to or exceeds VREFH, the converter circuit converts the signal to $3FF (full scale 10-bit representation) or $FF (full scale 8-bit representation). If the input is equal to or less than VREFL, the converter circuit converts it to $000. Input voltages between VREFH and VREFL are straight-line linear conversions. There will be a brief current associated with VREFL when the sampling capacitor is charging. The input is sampled for 3.5 cycles of the ADCK source when ADLSMP is low, or 23.5 cycles when ADLSMP is high. For minimal loss of accuracy due to current injection, pins adjacent to the analog input pins must not be transitioning during conversions. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 118 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) 8.6.2 Sources of Error Several sources of error exist for A/D conversions. These are discussed in the following sections. 8.6.2.1 Sampling Error For proper conversions, the input must be sampled long enough to achieve the proper accuracy. Given the maximum input resistance of approximately 7kΩ and input capacitance of approximately 5.5 pF, sampling to within 1/4LSB (at 10-bit resolution) can be achieved within the minimum sample window (3.5 cycles @ 8 MHz maximum ADCK frequency) provided the resistance of the external analog source (RAS) is kept below 5 kΩ. Higher source resistances or higher-accuracy sampling is possible by setting ADLSMP (to increase the sample window to 23.5 cycles) or decreasing ADCK frequency to increase sample time. 8.6.2.2 Pin Leakage Error Leakage on the I/O pins can cause conversion error if the external analog source resistance (RAS) is high. If this error cannot be tolerated by the application, keep RAS lower than VDDAD / (2N*ILEAK) for less than 1/4LSB leakage error (N = 8 in 8-bit mode or 10 in 10-bit mode). 8.6.2.3 Noise-Induced Errors System noise which occurs during the sample or conversion process can affect the accuracy of the conversion. The ADC accuracy numbers are guaranteed as specified only if the following conditions are met: • There is a 0.1 μF low-ESR capacitor from VREFH to VREFL. • There is a 0.1 μF low-ESR capacitor from VDDAD to VSSAD. • If inductive isolation is used from the primary supply, an additional 1 μF capacitor is placed from VDDAD to VSSAD. • VSSAD (and VREFL, if connected) is connected to VSS at a quiet point in the ground plane. • Operate the MCU in wait or stop3 mode before initiating (hardware triggered conversions) or immediately after initiating (hardware or software triggered conversions) the ADC conversion. — For software triggered conversions, immediately follow the write to the ADCSC1 with a WAIT instruction or STOP instruction. — For stop3 mode operation, select ADACK as the clock source. Operation in stop3 reduces VDD noise but increases effective conversion time due to stop recovery. • There is no I/O switching, input or output, on the MCU during the conversion. There are some situations where external system activity causes radiated or conducted noise emissions or excessive VDD noise is coupled into the ADC. In these situations, or when the MCU cannot be placed in wait or stop3 or I/O activity cannot be halted, these recommended actions may reduce the effect of noise on the accuracy: • Place a 0.01 μF capacitor (CAS) on the selected input channel to VREFL or VSSAD (this will improve noise issues but will affect sample rate based on the external analog source resistance). MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 119 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) • • Average the result by converting the analog input many times in succession and dividing the sum of the results. Four samples are required to eliminate the effect of a 1LSB, one-time error. Reduce the effect of synchronous noise by operating off the asynchronous clock (ADACK) and averaging. Noise that is synchronous to ADCK cannot be averaged out. 8.6.2.4 Code Width and Quantization Error The ADC quantizes the ideal straight-line transfer function into 1024 steps (in 10-bit mode). Each step ideally has the same height (1 code) and width. The width is defined as the delta between the transition points to one code and the next. The ideal code width for an N bit converter (in this case N can be 8 or 10), defined as 1LSB, is: 1LSB = (VREFH - VREFL) / 2N Eqn. 8-2 There is an inherent quantization error due to the digitization of the result. For 8-bit or 10-bit conversions the code will transition when the voltage is at the midpoint between the points where the straight line transfer function is exactly represented by the actual transfer function. Therefore, the quantization error will be ± 1/2LSB in 8- or 10-bit mode. As a consequence, however, the code width of the first ($000) conversion is only 1/2LSB and the code width of the last ($FF or $3FF) is 1.5LSB. 8.6.2.5 Linearity Errors The ADC may also exhibit non-linearity of several forms. Every effort has been made to reduce these errors but the system must be aware of them because they affect overall accuracy. These errors are: • Zero-scale error (EZS) (sometimes called offset) — This error is defined as the difference between the actual code width of the first conversion and the ideal code width (1/2LSB). Note, if the first conversion is $001, then the difference between the actual $001 code width and its ideal (1LSB) is used. • Full-scale error (EFS) — This error is defined as the difference between the actual code width of the last conversion and the ideal code width (1.5LSB). Note, if the last conversion is $3FE, then the difference between the actual $3FE code width and its ideal (1LSB) is used. • Differential non-linearity (DNL) — This error is defined as the worst-case difference between the actual code width and the ideal code width for all conversions. • Integral non-linearity (INL) — This error is defined as the highest-value the (absolute value of the) running sum of DNL achieves. More simply, this is the worst-case difference of the actual transition voltage to a given code and its corresponding ideal transition voltage, for all codes. • Total unadjusted error (TUE) — This error is defined as the difference between the actual transfer function and the ideal straight-line transfer function, and therefore includes all forms of error. 8.6.2.6 Code Jitter, Non-Monotonicity and Missing Codes Analog-to-digital converters are susceptible to three special forms of error. These are code jitter, non-monotonicity, and missing codes. Code jitter is when, at certain points, a given input voltage converts to one of two values when sampled repeatedly. Ideally, when the input voltage is infinitesimally smaller than the transition voltage, the MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 120 Freescale Semiconductor Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) converter yields the lower code (and vice-versa). However, even very small amounts of system noise can cause the converter to be indeterminate (between two codes) for a range of input voltages around the transition voltage. This range is normally around ±1/2 LSB and will increase with noise. This error may be reduced by repeatedly sampling the input and averaging the result. Additionally the techniques discussed in Section 8.6.2.3, “Noise-Induced Errors,” will reduce this error. Non-monotonicity is defined as when, except for code jitter, the converter converts to a lower code for a higher input voltage. Missing codes are those values which are never converted for any input value. In 8-bit or 10-bit mode, the ADC is guaranteed to be monotonic and to have no missing codes. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 121 Analog-to-Digital Converter (S08ADC10V1) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 122 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 9 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.1 Introduction The internal clock source (ICS) module provides clock source choices for the MCU. The module contains a frequency-locked loop (FLL) as a clock source that is controllable by an internal reference clock. The module can provide this FLL clock or the internal reference clock as a source for the MCU system clock, ICSOUT. Whichever clock source is chosen, ICSOUT is passed through a bus clock divider (BDIV) which allows a lower final output clock frequency to be derived. ICSOUT is two times the bus frequency. Figure 9-1 Shows the MC9S08QD4 series with the ICS module highlighted. 9.1.1 ICS Configuration Information Bit-1 and bit-2 of ICS control register 1 (ICSC1) always read as 1. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 123 Chapter 9 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) BKGD/MS IRQ HCS08 CORE BDC HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT RTI COP IRQ LVD USER FLASH 4096 / 2048 BYTES 4-BIT KEYBOARD INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI) 4 TPM2CH0 1-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) TCLK2 2-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) TPM1CH0 TPM1CH1 TCLK1 10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) PORT A CPU PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS PTA3/KBI1P3/TCLK2/ADC1P3 PTA2/KBI1P2/TCLK1/ADC1P2 PTA1/KBI1P1/TPM1CH1/ADC1P1 PTA0/KBI1P0/TPM1CH0/ADC1P0 4 USER RAM 256 / 128 BYTES 16 MHz INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE (ICS) VSS VDD VOLTAGE REGULATOR VDDA VSSA VREFH VREFL NOTES: 1 Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port. 2 Port pins are software configurable for output drive strength. 3 Port pins are software configurable for output slew rate control. 4 IRQ contains a software configurable (IRQPDD) pullup/pulldown device if PTA5 enabled as IRQ pin function (IRQPE = 1). 5 RESET contains integrated pullup device if PTA5 enabled as reset pin function (RSTPE = 1). 6 PTA5 does not contain a clamp diode to VDD and must not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on this pin when internal pullup is enabled may be as low as VDD – 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled to VDD. 7 PTA4 contains integrated pullup device if BKGD enabled (BKGDPE = 1). 8 When pin functions as KBI (KBIPEn = 1) and associated pin is configured to enable the pullup device, KBEDGn can be used to reconfigure the pullup as a pulldown device. Figure 9-1. MC9S08QD4 Series Block Diagram Highlighting ICS Block MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 124 Freescale Semiconductor Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.1.2 Features Key features of the ICS module are: • Frequency-locked loop (FLL) is trimmable for accuracy — 0.2% resolution using internal 32 kHz reference — 2% deviation over voltage and temperature using internal 32 kHz reference • Internal or external reference clocks up to 5 MHz can be used to control the FLL — 3 bit select for reference divider is provided • Internal reference clock has 9 trim bits available • Internal or external reference clocks can be selected as the clock source for the MCU • Whichever clock is selected as the source can be divided down — 2 bit select for clock divider is provided – Allowable dividers are: 1, 2, 4, 8 – BDC clock is provided as a constant divide by 2 of the DCO output • Control signals for a low power oscillator as the external reference clock are provided — HGO, RANGE, EREFS, ERCLKEN, EREFSTEN • FLL engaged internal mode is automatically selected out of reset 9.1.3 Modes of Operation There are seven modes of operation for the ICS: FEI, FEE, FBI, FBILP, FBE, FBELP, and stop. 9.1.3.1 FLL Engaged Internal (FEI) In FLL engaged internal mode, which is the default mode, the ICS supplies a clock derived from the FLL which is controlled by the internal reference clock. The BDC clock is supplied from the FLL. 9.1.3.2 FLL Engaged External (FEE) In FLL engaged external mode, the ICS supplies a clock derived from the FLL which is controlled by an external reference clock. The BDC clock is supplied from the FLL. 9.1.3.3 FLL Bypassed Internal (FBI) In FLL bypassed internal mode, the FLL is enabled and controlled by the internal reference clock, but is bypassed. The ICS supplies a clock derived from the internal reference clock. The BDC clock is supplied from the FLL. 9.1.3.4 FLL Bypassed Internal Low Power (FBILP) In FLL bypassed internal low power mode, the FLL is disabled and bypassed, and the ICS supplies a clock derived from the internal reference clock. The BDC clock is not available. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 125 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.1.3.5 FLL Bypassed External (FBE) In FLL bypassed external mode, the FLL is enabled and controlled by an external reference clock, but is bypassed. The ICS supplies a clock derived from the external reference clock. The external reference clock can be an external crystal/resonator supplied by an OSC controlled by the ICS, or it can be another external clock source. The BDC clock is supplied from the FLL. 9.1.3.6 FLL Bypassed External Low Power (FBELP) In FLL bypassed external low power mode, the FLL is disabled and bypassed, and the ICS supplies a clock derived from the external reference clock. The external reference clock can be an external crystal/resonator supplied by an OSC controlled by the ICS, or it can be another external clock source. The BDC clock is not available. 9.1.3.7 Stop (STOP) In stop mode the FLL is disabled and the internal or external reference clocks can be selected to be enabled or disabled. The BDC clock is not available and the ICS does not provide an MCU clock source. 9.1.4 Block Diagram Figure 9-2 is the ICS block diagram. Optional External Reference Clock Source Block RANGE HGO EREFS EREFSTEN ICSERCLK ERCLKEN IRCLKEN IREFSTEN ICSIRCLK CLKS BDIV / 2n Internal Reference Clock 9 IREFS ICSOUT n=0-3 LP DCO DCOOUT /2 ICSLCLK TRIM ICSFFCLK 9 / 2n RDIV_CLK Filter n=0-7 FLL RDIV Internal Clock Source Block Figure 9-2. Internal Clock Source (ICS) Block Diagram MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 126 Freescale Semiconductor Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.2 External Signal Description There are no ICS signals that connect off chip. 9.3 Register Definition 9.3.1 ICS Control Register 1 (ICSC1) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 IREFS IRCLKEN IREFSTEN 1 0 0 R CLKS RDIV W Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 9-3. ICS Control Register 1 (ICSC1) Table 9-1. ICS Control Register 1 Field Descriptions Field Description 7:6 CLKS Clock Source Select — Selects the clock source that controls the bus frequency. The actual bus frequency depends on the value of the BDIV bits. 00 Output of FLL is selected. 01 Internal reference clock is selected. 10 External reference clock is selected. 11 Reserved, defaults to 00. 5:3 RDIV Reference Divider — Selects the amount to divide down the FLL reference clock selected by the IREFS bits. Resulting frequency must be in the range 31.25 kHz to 39.0625 kHz. 000 Encoding 0 — Divides reference clock by 1 (reset default) 001 Encoding 1 — Divides reference clock by 2 010 Encoding 2 — Divides reference clock by 4 011 Encoding 3 — Divides reference clock by 8 100 Encoding 4 — Divides reference clock by 16 101 Encoding 5 — Divides reference clock by 32 110 Encoding 6 — Divides reference clock by 64 111 Encoding 7 — Divides reference clock by 128 2 IREFS Internal Reference Select — The IREFS bit selects the reference clock source for the FLL. 1 Internal reference clock selected 0 External reference clock selected 1 IRCLKEN 0 IREFSTEN Internal Reference Clock Enable — The IRCLKEN bit enables the internal reference clock for use as ICSIRCLK. 1 ICSIRCLK active 0 ICSIRCLK inactive Internal Reference Stop Enable — The IREFSTEN bit controls whether or not the internal reference clock remains enabled when the ICS enters stop mode. 1 Internal reference clock stays enabled in stop if IRCLKEN is set or if ICS is in FEI, FBI, or FBILP mode before entering stop 0 Internal reference clock is disabled in stop MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 127 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.3.2 ICS Control Register 2 (ICSC2) 7 6 5 4 3 2 RANGE HGO LP EREFS 0 0 0 0 1 0 R BDIV ERCLKEN EREFSTEN W Reset: 0 1 0 0 Figure 9-4. ICS Control Register 2 (ICSC2) Table 9-2. ICS Control Register 2 Field Descriptions Field Description 7:6 BDIV Bus Frequency Divider — Selects the amount to divide down the clock source selected by the CLKS bits. This controls the bus frequency. 00 Encoding 0 — Divides selected clock by 1 01 Encoding 1 — Divides selected clock by 2 (reset default) 10 Encoding 2 — Divides selected clock by 4 11 Encoding 3 — Divides selected clock by 8 5 RANGE Frequency Range Select — Selects the frequency range for the external oscillator. 1 High frequency range selected for the external oscillator 0 Low frequency range selected for the external oscillator 4 HGO High Gain Oscillator Select — The HGO bit controls the external oscillator mode of operation. 1 Configure external oscillator for high gain operation 0 Configure external oscillator for low power operation 3 LP Low Power Select — The LP bit controls whether the FLL is disabled in FLL bypassed modes. 1 FLL is disabled in bypass modes unless BDM is active 0 FLL is not disabled in bypass mode 2 EREFS 1 ERCLKEN External Reference Select — The EREFS bit selects the source for the external reference clock. 1 Oscillator requested 0 External Clock Source requested External Reference Enable — The ERCLKEN bit enables the external reference clock for use as ICSERCLK. 1 ICSERCLK active 0 ICSERCLK inactive 0 External Reference Stop Enable — The EREFSTEN bit controls whether or not the external reference clock EREFSTEN remains enabled when the ICS enters stop mode. 1 External reference clock stays enabled in stop if ERCLKEN is set or if ICS is in FEE, FBE, or FBELP mode before entering stop 0 External reference clock is disabled in stop MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 128 Freescale Semiconductor Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.3.3 ICS Trim Register (ICSTRM) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 R TRIM W POR: 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Reset: U U U U U U U U Figure 9-5. ICS Trim Register (ICSTRM) Table 9-3. ICS Trim Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7:0 TRIM ICS Trim Setting — The TRIM bits control the internal reference clock frequency by controlling the internal reference clock period. The bits’ effect are binary weighted (i.e., bit 1 will adjust twice as much as bit 0). Increasing the binary value in TRIM will increase the period, and decreasing the value will decrease the period. An additional fine trim bit is available in ICSSC as the FTRIM bit. 9.3.4 ICS Status and Control (ICSSC) R 7 6 5 4 0 0 0 0 3 2 CLKST 1 0 OSCINIT FTRIM W POR: Reset: 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 U Figure 9-6. ICS Status and Control Register (ICSSC) Table 9-4. ICS Status and Control Register Field Descriptions Field 7:4 3:2 CLKST Description Reserved, must be cleared. Clock Mode Status — The CLKST bits indicate the current clock mode. The CLKST bits don’t update immediately after a write to the CLKS bits due to internal synchronization between clock domains. 00 Output of FLL is selected. 01 FLL Bypassed, Internal reference clock is selected. 10 FLL Bypassed, External reference clock is selected. 11 Reserved. 1 OSC Initialization — If the external reference clock is selected by ERCLKEN or by the ICS being in FEE, FBE, or FBELP mode, and if EREFS is set, then this bit is set after the initialization cycles of the external oscillator clock have completed. This bit is cleared only when either ERCLKEN or EREFS are cleared. 0 ICS Fine Trim — The FTRIM bit controls the smallest adjustment of the internal reference clock frequency. Setting FTRIM will increase the period and clearing FTRIM will decrease the period by the smallest amount possible. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 129 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.4 Functional Description 9.4.1 Operational Modes IREFS=1 CLKS=00 FLL Engaged Internal (FEI) IREFS=0 CLKS=10 BDM Enabled or LP =0 FLL Bypassed External Low Power(FBELP) FLL Bypassed External (FBE) IREFS=0 CLKS=10 BDM Disabled and LP=1 IREFS=1 CLKS=01 BDM Enabled or LP=0 FLL Bypassed Internal (FBI) FLL Bypassed Internal Low Power(FBILP) IREFS=1 CLKS=01 BDM Disabled and LP=1 FLL Engaged External (FEE) IREFS=0 CLKS=00 Entered from any state when MCU enters stop Stop Returns to state that was active before MCU entered stop, unless reset occurs while in stop. Figure 9-7. Clock Switching Modes The seven states of the ICS are shown as a state diagram and are described below. The arrows indicate the allowed movements between the states. 9.4.1.1 FLL Engaged Internal (FEI) FLL engaged internal (FEI) is the default mode of operation and is entered when all the following conditions occur: • CLKS bits are written to 00 • IREFS bit is written to 1 • RDIV bits are written to divide trimmed reference clock to be within the range of 31.25 kHz to 39.0625 kHz. In FLL engaged internal mode, the ICSOUT clock is derived from the FLL clock, which is controlled by the internal reference clock. The FLL loop will lock the frequency to 512 times the filter frequency, as selected by the RDIV bits. The ICSLCLK is available for BDC communications, and the internal reference clock is enabled. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 130 Freescale Semiconductor Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.4.1.2 FLL Engaged External (FEE) The FLL engaged external (FEE) mode is entered when all the following conditions occur: • • • CLKS bits are written to 00 IREFS bit is written to 0 RDIV bits are written to divide reference clock to be within the range of 31.25 kHz to 39.0625 kHz In FLL engaged external mode, the ICSOUT clock is derived from the FLL clock which is controlled by the external reference clock.The FLL loop will lock the frequency to 512 times the filter frequency, as selected by the RDIV bits. The ICSLCLK is available for BDC communications, and the external reference clock is enabled. 9.4.1.3 FLL Bypassed Internal (FBI) The FLL bypassed internal (FBI) mode is entered when all the following conditions occur: • CLKS bits are written to 01 • IREFS bit is written to 1. • BDM mode is active or LP bit is written to 0 In FLL bypassed internal mode, the ICSOUT clock is derived from the internal reference clock. The FLL clock is controlled by the internal reference clock, and the FLL loop will lock the FLL frequency to 512 times the Filter frequency, as selected by the RDIV bits. The ICSLCLK will be available for BDC communications, and the internal reference clock is enabled. 9.4.1.4 FLL Bypassed Internal Low Power (FBILP) The FLL bypassed internal low power (FBILP) mode is entered when all the following conditions occur: • CLKS bits are written to 01 • IREFS bit is written to 1. • BDM mode is not active and LP bit is written to 1 In FLL bypassed internal low power mode, the ICSOUT clock is derived from the internal reference clock and the FLL is disabled. The ICSLCLK will be not be available for BDC communications, and the internal reference clock is enabled. 9.4.1.5 FLL Bypassed External (FBE) The FLL bypassed external (FBE) mode is entered when all the following conditions occur: • CLKS bits are written to 10. • IREFS bit is written to 0. • BDM mode is active or LP bit is written to 0. In FLL bypassed external mode, the ICSOUT clock is derived from the external reference clock. The FLL clock is controlled by the external reference clock, and the FLL loop will lock the FLL frequency to 512 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 131 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) times the filter frequency, as selected by the RDIV bits, so that the ICSLCLK will be available for BDC communications, and the external reference clock is enabled. 9.4.1.6 FLL Bypassed External Low Power (FBELP) The FLL bypassed external low power (FBELP) mode is entered when all the following conditions occur: • CLKS bits are written to 10. • IREFS bit is written to 0. • BDM mode is not active and LP bit is written to 1. In FLL bypassed external low power mode, the ICSOUT clock is derived from the external reference clock and the FLL is disabled. The ICSLCLK will be not be available for BDC communications. The external reference clock is enabled. 9.4.1.7 Stop Stop mode is entered whenever the MCU enters a STOP state. In this mode, all ICS clock signals are static except in the following cases: ICSIRCLK will be active in stop mode when all the following conditions occur: • IRCLKEN bit is written to 1 • IREFSTEN bit is written to 1 ICSERCLK will be active in stop mode when all the following conditions occur: • ERCLKEN bit is written to 1 • EREFSTEN bit is written to 1 9.4.2 Mode Switching When switching between FLL engaged internal (FEI) and FLL engaged external (FEE) modes the IREFS bit can be changed at anytime, but the RDIV bits must be changed simultaneously so that the resulting frequency stays in the range of 31.25 kHz to 39.0625 kHz. After a change in the IREFS value the FLL will begin locking again after a few full cycles of the resulting divided reference frequency. The CLKS bits can also be changed at anytime, but the RDIV bits must be changed simultaneously so that the resulting frequency stays in the range of 31.25 kHz to 39.0625 kHz. The actual switch to the newly selected clock will not occur until after a few full cycles of the new clock. If the newly selected clock is not available, the previous clock will remain selected. 9.4.3 Bus Frequency Divider The BDIV bits can be changed at anytime and the actual switch to the new frequency will occur immediately. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 132 Freescale Semiconductor Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.4.4 Low Power Bit Usage The low power bit (LP) is provided to allow the FLL to be disabled and thus conserve power when it is not being used. However, in some applications it may be desirable to enable the FLL and allow it to lock for maximum accuracy before switching to an FLL engaged mode. Do this by writing the LP bit to 0. 9.4.5 Internal Reference Clock When IRCLKEN is set the internal reference clock signal will be presented as ICSIRCLK, which can be used as an additional clock source. The ICSIRCLK frequency can be re-targeted by trimming the period of the internal reference clock. This can be done by writing a new value to the TRIM bits in the ICSTRM register. Writing a larger value will slow down the ICSIRCLK frequency, and writing a smaller value to the ICSTRM register will speed up the ICSIRCLK frequency. The TRIM bits will effect the ICSOUT frequency if the ICS is in FLL engaged internal (FEI), FLL bypassed internal (FBI), or FLL bypassed internal low power (FBILP) mode. The TRIM and FTRIM value will not be affected by a reset. Until ICSIRCLK is trimmed, programming low reference divider (RDIV) factors may result in ICSOUT frequencies that exceed the maximum chip-level frequency and violate the chip-level clock timing specifications (see the Device Overview chapter). If IREFSTEN is set and the IRCLKEN bit is written to 1, the internal reference clock will keep running during stop mode in order to provide a fast recovery upon exiting stop. All MCU devices are factory programmed with a trim value in a reserved memory location. This value can be copied to the ICSTRM register during reset initialization. The factory trim value does not include the FTRIM bit. For finer precision, the user can trim the internal oscillator in the application and set the FTRIM bit accordingly. 9.4.6 Optional External Reference Clock The ICS module can support an external reference clock with frequencies between 31.25 kHz to 5 MHz in all modes. When the ERCLKEN is set, the external reference clock signal will be presented as ICSERCLK, which can be used as an additional clock source. When IREFS = 1, the external reference clock will not be used by the FLL and will only be used as ICSERCLK. In these modes, the frequency can be equal to the maximum frequency the chip-level timing specifications will support (see the Device Overview chapter). If EREFSTEN is set and the ERCLKEN bit is written to 1, the external reference clock will keep running during stop mode in order to provide a fast recovery upon exiting stop. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 133 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) 9.4.7 Fixed Frequency Clock The ICS presents the divided FLL reference clock as ICSFFCLK for use as an additional clock source for peripheral modules. The ICS provides an output signal (ICSFFE) which indicates when the ICS is providing ICSOUT frequencies four times or greater than the divided FLL reference clock (ICSFFCLK). In FLL engaged mode (FEI and FEE) this is always true and ICSFFE is always high. In ICS bypass modes, ICSFFE will get asserted for the following combinations of BDIV and RDIV values: • BDIV=00 (divide by 1), RDIV ≥ 010 • BDIV=01 (divide by 2), RDIV ≥ 011 • BDIV=10 (divide by 4), RDIV ≥ 100 • BDIV=11 (divide by 8), RDIV ≥ 101 9.5 Module Initialization This section describes how to initialize and configure the ICS module. The following sections contain two initialization examples. 9.5.1 ICS Module Initialization Sequence The ICS comes out of POR configured for FEI mode with the BDIV set for divide-by 2. The internal reference will stabilize in tIRST microseconds before the FLL can acquire lock. As soon as the internal reference is stable, the FLL will acquire lock in tAcquire milliseconds. Upon POR, the internal reference will require trimming to guarantee an accurate clock. Freescale recommends using FLASH location 0xFFAE for storing the fine trim bit, FTRIM in the ICSSC register, and 0xFFAF for storing the 8-bit trim value for the ICSTRM register. The MCU will not automatically copy the values in these FLASH locations to the respective registers. Therefore, user code must copy these values from FLASH to the registers. NOTE The BDIV value must not be changed to divide-by 1 without first trimming the internal reference. Failure to do so could result in the MCU running out of specification. 9.5.1.1 Initialization Sequence, Internal Clock Mode to External Clock Mode To change from FEI or FBI clock modes to FEE or FBE clock modes, follow this procedure: 1. Enable the external clock source by setting the appropriate bits in ICSC2. — If FBE will be the selected mode, also set the LP bit at this time to minimize power consumption. 2. If necessary, wait for the external clock source to stabilize. Typical crystal startup times are given in Electrical Characteristics appendix. If EREFS is set in step 1, then the OSCINIT bit will set as soon as the oscillator has completed the initialization cycles. 3. Write to ICSC1 to select the clock mode. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 134 Freescale Semiconductor Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) — If entering FEE, set the reference divider and clear the IREFS bit to switch to the external reference. — The internal reference can optionally be kept running by setting the IRCLKEN bit. This is useful if the application will switch back and forth between internal clock and external clock modes. For minimum power consumption, leave the internal reference disabled while in an external clock mode. 4. The CLKST bits can be monitored to determine when the mode switch has completed. If FEE was selected, the bus clock will be stable in tAcquire milliseconds. The CLKST bits will not change when switching from FEI to FEE. 9.5.1.2 Initialization Sequence, External Clock Mode to Internal Clock Mode To change from FEE or FBE clock modes to FEI or FBI clock modes, follow this procedure: 1. If saved, copy the TRIM and FTRIM values from FLASH to the ICSTRM and ICSSC registers. This needs to be done only once after POR. 2. Enable the internal clock reference by selecting FBI (CLKS = 0:1) or selecting FEI (CLKS = 0:0, RDIV = 0:0:0, and IREFS = 1) in ICSC1. 3. Wait for the internal clock reference to stabilize. The typical startup time is given in the Electrical Characteristics appendix. 4. Write to ICSC2 to disable the external clock. — The external reference can optionally be kept running by setting the ERCLKEN bit. This is useful if the application will switch back and forth between internal clock and external clock modes. For minimum power consumption, leave the external reference disabled while in an internal clock mode. — If FBI will be the selected mode, also set the LP bit at this time to minimize power consumption. NOTE The internal reference must be enabled and running before disabling the external clock. Therefore it is imperative to execute steps 2 and 3 before step 4. 5. The CLKST bits in the ICSSC register can be monitored to determine when the mode switch has completed. The CLKST bits will not change when switching from FEE to FEI. If FEI was selected, the bus clock will be stable in tAcquire milliseconds. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 135 Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 136 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 10 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV2) 10.1 Introduction The keyboard interrupt KBI module provides up to eight independently enabled external interrupt sources. Only four (KBI1P0–KBI1P3) of the possible interrupts are implemented on the MC9S08QD4 series MCU. These inputs are selected by the KBIPE bits. Figure 10-1 Shows the MC9S08QD4 series with the KBI module and pins highlighted. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 137 Chapter 10 Keyboard Interrupt (S08KBIV2) BKGD/MS IRQ HCS08 CORE BDC HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT RTI COP IRQ LVD USER FLASH 4096 / 2048 BYTES 4-BIT KEYBOARD INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI) 4 TPM2CH0 1-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) TCLK2 2-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) TPM1CH0 TPM1CH1 TCLK1 10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) PORT A CPU PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS PTA3/KBI1P3/TCLK2/ADC1P3 PTA2/KBI1P2/TCLK1/ADC1P2 PTA1/KBI1P1/TPM1CH1/ADC1P1 PTA0/KBI1P0/TPM1CH0/ADC1P0 4 USER RAM 256 / 128 BYTES 16 MHz INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE (ICS) VSS VDD VOLTAGE REGULATOR VDDA VSSA VREFH VREFL NOTES: 1 Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port. 2 Port pins are software configurable for output drive strength. 3 Port pins are software configurable for output slew rate control. 4 IRQ contains a software configurable (IRQPDD) pullup/pulldown device if PTA5 enabled as IRQ pin function (IRQPE = 1). 5 RESET contains integrated pullup device if PTA5 enabled as reset pin function (RSTPE = 1). 6 PTA5 does not contain a clamp diode to V DD and must not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on this pin when internal pullup is enabled may be as low as VDD – 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled to VDD. 7 PTA4 contains integrated pullup device if BKGD enabled (BKGDPE = 1). 8 When pin functions as KBI (KBIPEn = 1) and associated pin is configured to enable the pullup device, KBEDGn can be used to reconfigure the pullup as a pulldown device. Figure 10-1. MC9S08QD4 Series Block Diagram Highlighting KBI Block and Pins MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 138 Freescale Semiconductor Keyboard Interrupts (S08KBIV2) 10.1.1 Features The KBI features include: • Up to eight keyboard interrupt pins with individual pin enable bits. • Each keyboard interrupt pin is programmable as falling edge (or rising edge) only, or both falling edge and low level (or both rising edge and high level) interrupt sensitivity. • One software enabled keyboard interrupt. • Exit from low-power modes. 10.1.2 Modes of Operation This section defines the KBI operation in wait, stop, and background debug modes. 10.1.2.1 KBI in Wait Mode The KBI continues to operate in wait mode if enabled before executing the WAIT instruction. Therefore, an enabled KBI pin (KBPEx = 1) can be used to bring the MCU out of wait mode if the KBI interrupt is enabled (KBIE = 1). 10.1.2.2 KBI in Stop Modes The KBI operates asynchronously in stop3 mode if enabled before executing the STOP instruction. Therefore, an enabled KBI pin (KBPEx = 1) can be used to bring the MCU out of stop3 mode if the KBI interrupt is enabled (KBIE = 1). During either stop1 or stop2 mode, the KBI is disabled. In some systems, the pins associated with the KBI may be sources of wakeup from stop1 or stop2, see the stop modes section in the Modes of Operation chapter. Upon wake-up from stop1 or stop2 mode, the KBI module will be in the reset state. 10.1.2.3 KBI in Active Background Mode When the microcontroller is in active background mode, the KBI will continue to operate normally. 10.1.3 Block Diagram The block diagram for the keyboard interrupt module is shown Figure 10-2. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 139 Keyboard Interrupts (S08KBIV2) BUSCLK KBACK VDD 1 KBIP0 0 S RESET KBF D CLR Q KBIPE0 SYNCHRONIZER CK KBEDG0 KEYBOARD INTERRUPT FF 1 KBIPn 0 S STOP STOP BYPASS KBI INTERRU PT KBMOD KBIPEn KBIE KBEDGn Figure 10-2. KBI Block Diagram 10.2 External Signal Description The KBI input pins can be used to detect either falling edges, or both falling edge and low level interrupt requests. The KBI input pins can also be used to detect either rising edges, or both rising edge and high level interrupt requests. The signal properties of KBI are shown in Table 10-1. Table 10-1. Signal Properties Signal Function KBIPn 10.3 Keyboard interrupt pins I/O I Register Definition The KBI includes three registers: • An 8-bit pin status and control register. • An 8-bit pin enable register. • An 8-bit edge select register. Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter for the absolute address assignments for all KBI registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. Some MCUs may have more than one KBI, so register names include placeholder characters to identify which KBI is being referenced. 10.3.1 KBI Status and Control Register (KBISC) KBISC contains the status flag and control bits, which are used to configure the KBI. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 140 Freescale Semiconductor Keyboard Interrupts (S08KBIV2) R 7 6 5 4 3 2 0 0 0 0 KBF 0 W Reset: 1 0 KBIE KBMOD 0 0 KBACK 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented Figure 10-3. KBI Status and Control Register Table 10-2. KBISC Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7:4 Unused register bits, always read 0. 3 KBF Keyboard Interrupt Flag — KBF indicates when a keyboard interrupt is detected. Writes have no effect on KBF. 0 No keyboard interrupt detected. 1 Keyboard interrupt detected. 2 KBACK Keyboard Acknowledge — Writing a 1 to KBACK is part of the flag clearing mechanism. KBACK always reads as 0. 1 KBIE Keyboard Interrupt Enable — KBIE determines whether a keyboard interrupt is requested. 0 Keyboard interrupt request not enabled. 1 Keyboard interrupt request enabled. 0 KBMOD 10.3.2 Keyboard Detection Mode — KBMOD (along with the KBEDG bits) controls the detection mode of the keyboard interrupt pins.0Keyboard detects edges only. 1 Keyboard detects both edges and levels. KBI Pin Enable Register (KBIPE) KBIPE contains the pin enable control bits. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 KBIPE7 KBIPE6 KBIPE5 KBIPE4 KBIPE3 KBIPE2 KBIPE1 KBIPE0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset: Figure 10-4. KBI Pin Enable Register Table 10-3. KBIPE Register Field Descriptions Field 7:0 KBIPEn 10.3.3 Description Keyboard Pin Enables — Each of the KBIPEn bits enable the corresponding keyboard interrupt pin. 0 Pin not enabled as keyboard interrupt. 1 Pin enabled as keyboard interrupt. KBI Edge Select Register (KBIES) KBIES contains the edge select control bits. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 141 Keyboard Interrupts (S08KBIV2) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 KBEDG7 KBEDG6 KBEDG5 KBEDG4 KBEDG3 KBEDG2 KBEDG1 KBEDG0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset: Figure 10-5. KBI Edge Select Register Table 10-4. KBIES Register Field Descriptions Field 7:0 KBEDGn 10.4 Description Keyboard Edge Selects — Each of the KBEDGn bits selects the falling edge/low level or rising edge/high level function of the corresponding pin). 0 Falling edge/low level. 1 Rising edge/high level. Functional Description This on-chip peripheral module is called a keyboard interrupt (KBI) module because originally it was designed to simplify the connection and use of row-column matrices of keyboard switches. However, these inputs are also useful as extra external interrupt inputs and as an external means of waking the MCU from stop or wait low-power modes. The KBI module allows up to eight pins to act as additional interrupt sources. Writing to the KBIPEn bits in the keyboard interrupt pin enable register (KBIPE) independently enables or disables each KBI pin. Each KBI pin can be configured as edge sensitive or edge and level sensitive based on the KBMOD bit in the keyboard interrupt status and control register (KBISC). Edge sensitive can be software programmed to be either falling or rising; the level can be either low or high. The polarity of the edge or edge and level sensitivity is selected using the KBEDGn bits in the keyboard interrupt edge select register (KBIES). 10.4.1 Edge Only Sensitivity Synchronous logic is used to detect edges. A falling edge is detected when an enabled keyboard interrupt (KBIPEn=1) input signal is seen as a logic 1 (the deasserted level) during one bus cycle and then a logic 0 (the asserted level) during the next cycle. A rising edge is detected when the input signal is seen as a logic 0 (the deasserted level) during one bus cycle and then a logic 1 (the asserted level) during the next cycle.Before the first edge is detected, all enabled keyboard interrupt input signals must be at the deasserted logic levels. After any edge is detected, all enabled keyboard interrupt input signals must return to the deasserted level before any new edge can be detected. A valid edge on an enabled KBI pin will set KBF in KBISC. If KBIE in KBISC is set, an interrupt request will be presented to the CPU. Clearing of KBF is accomplished by writing a 1 to KBACK in KBISC. 10.4.2 Edge and Level Sensitivity A valid edge or level on an enabled KBI pin will set KBF in KBISC. If KBIE in KBISC is set, an interrupt request will be presented to the CPU. Clearing of KBF is accomplished by writing a 1 to KBACK in MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 142 Freescale Semiconductor Keyboard Interrupts (S08KBIV2) KBISC provided all enabled keyboard inputs are at their deasserted levels. KBF will remain set if any enabled KBI pin is asserted while attempting to clear by writing a 1 to KBACK. 10.4.3 KBI Pullup/Pulldown Resistors The KBI pins can be configured to use an internal pullup/pulldown resistor using the associated I/O port pullup enable register. If an internal resistor is enabled, the KBIES register is used to select whether the resistor is a pullup (KBEDGn = 0) or a pulldown (KBEDGn = 1). 10.4.4 KBI Initialization When a keyboard interrupt pin is first enabled it is possible to get a false keyboard interrupt flag. To prevent a false interrupt request during keyboard initialization, the user must do the following: 1. Mask keyboard interrupts by clearing KBIE in KBISC. 2. Enable the KBI polarity by setting the appropriate KBEDGn bits in KBIES. 3. If using internal pullup/pulldown device, configure the associated pullup enable bits in PTxPE. 4. Enable the KBI pins by setting the appropriate KBIPEn bits in KBIPE. 5. Write to KBACK in KBISC to clear any false interrupts. 6. Set KBIE in KBISC to enable interrupts. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 143 Keyboard Interrupts (S08KBIV2) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 144 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 11 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) 11.1 Introduction Figure 11-1 shows the MC9S08QD4 series block diagram with the TPM module and pins highlighted. 11.1.1 TPM2 Configuration Information The TPM2 module consist of a single channel, TPM2CH0, that is multiplexed with input pin PTA4 and output pin PTA5. When TPM2 is configured for input capture, the TPM2CH0 will connect to the PTA5 (TPM2CH0I). When TPM2 is configured for output compare, the TPM2CH0 will connect to the PTA4 (TPM2CH0O). When TPM2 is disabled, PTA4 and PTA5 function as standard port pins. 11.1.2 TCLK1 and TCLK2 Configuration Information The TCLK1 and TCLK2 are the external clock source inputs for TPM1 and TPM2 respectively. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 145 Chapter 11 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) BKGD/MS IRQ HCS08 CORE BDC HCS08 SYSTEM CONTROL RESETS AND INTERRUPTS MODES OF OPERATION POWER MANAGEMENT RTI COP IRQ LVD USER FLASH 4096 / 2048 BYTES 4-BIT KEYBOARD INTERRUPT MODULE (KBI) 4 TPM2CH0 1-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM2) TCLK2 2-CH 16-BIT TIMER/PWM MODULE (TPM1) TPM1CH0 TPM1CH1 TCLK1 10-BIT ANALOG-TO-DIGITAL CONVERTER (ADC) PORT A CPU PTA5/TPM2CH0I/IRQ/RESET PTA4/TPM2CH0O/BKGD/MS PTA3/KBI1P3/TCLK2/ADC1P3 PTA2/KBI1P2/TCLK1/ADC1P2 PTA1/KBI1P1/TPM1CH1/ADC1P1 PTA0/KBI1P0/TPM1CH0/ADC1P0 4 USER RAM 256 / 128 BYTES 16 MHz INTERNAL CLOCK SOURCE (ICS) VSS VDD VOLTAGE REGULATOR VDDA VSSA VREFH VREFL NOTES: 1 Port pins are software configurable with pullup device if input port. 2 Port pins are software configurable for output drive strength. 3 Port pins are software configurable for output slew rate control. 4 IRQ contains a software configurable (IRQPDD) pullup/pulldown device if PTA5 enabled as IRQ pin function (IRQPE = 1). 5 RESET contains integrated pullup device if PTA5 enabled as reset pin function (RSTPE = 1). 6 PTA5 does not contain a clamp diode to V DD and must not be driven above VDD. The voltage measured on this pin when internal pullup is enabled may be as low as VDD – 0.7 V. The internal gates connected to this pin are pulled to VDD. 7 PTA4 contains integrated pullup device if BKGD enabled (BKGDPE = 1). 8 When pin functions as KBI (KBIPEn = 1) and associated pin is configured to enable the pullup device, KBEDGn can be used to reconfigure the pullup as a pulldown device. Figure 11-1. MC9S08QD4 Series Block Diagram Highlighting TPM Block and Pins MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 146 Freescale Semiconductor Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) 11.1.3 Features The TPM has the following features: • Each TPM may be configured for buffered, center-aligned pulse-width modulation (CPWM) on all channels • Clock sources independently selectable per TPM (multiple TPMs device) • Selectable clock sources (device dependent): bus clock, fixed system clock, external pin • Clock prescaler taps for divide by 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128 • 16-bit free-running or up/down (CPWM) count operation • 16-bit modulus register to control counter range • Timer system enable • One interrupt per channel plus a terminal count interrupt for each TPM module (multiple TPMs device) • Channel features: — Each channel may be input capture, output compare, or buffered edge-aligned PWM — Rising-edge, falling-edge, or any-edge input capture trigger — Set, clear, or toggle output compare action — Selectable polarity on PWM outputs 11.1.4 Block Diagram Figure 11-2 shows the structure of a TPM. Some MCUs include more than one TPM, with various numbers of channels. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 147 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) BUSCLK XCLK TPMxCLK SYNC CLOCK SOURCE SELECT OFF, BUS, XCLK, EXT CLKSB PRESCALE AND SELECT DIVIDE BY 1, 2, 4, 8, 16, 32, 64, or 128 PS2 CLKSA PS1 PS0 CPWMS MAIN 16-BIT COUNTER TOF COUNTER RESET INTERRUPT LOGIC TOIE 16-BIT COMPARATOR TPMxMODH:TPMxMO CHANNEL 0 ELS0B ELS0A PORT LOGIC 16-BIT COMPARATOR TPMxC0VH:TPMxC0VL CH0F INTERRUPT LOGIC MS0B MS0A ELS1B ELS1A CH0IE TPMxC1VH:TPMxC1VL CH1F INTERRUPT LOGIC 16-BIT LATCH MS1A ELSnB ELSnA TPMxCHn PORT LOGIC 16-BIT COMPARATOR TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL ... MS1B CH1IE ... CHANNEL n TPMxCH1 PORT LOGIC 16-BIT COMPARATOR ... INTERNAL BUS 16-BIT LATCH CHANNEL 1 TPMxCH0 CHnF 16-BIT LATCH MSnB MSnA CHnIE INTERRUPT LOGIC Figure 11-2. TPM Block Diagram The central component of the TPM is the 16-bit counter that can operate as a free-running counter, a modulo counter, or an up-/down-counter when the TPM is configured for center-aligned PWM. The TPM counter (when operating in normal up-counting mode) provides the timing reference for the input capture, output compare, and edge-aligned PWM functions. The timer counter modulo registers, TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, control the modulo value of the counter. (The values 0x0000 or 0xFFFF effectively make the counter free running.) Software can read the counter value at any time without affecting the counting sequence. Any write to either byte of the TPMxCNT counter resets the counter regardless of the data value written. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 148 Freescale Semiconductor Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) All TPM channels are programmable independently as input capture, output compare, or buffered edge-aligned PWM channels. 11.2 External Signal Description When any pin associated with the timer is configured as a timer input, a passive pullup can be enabled. After reset, the TPM modules are disabled and all pins default to general-purpose inputs with the passive pullups disabled. 11.2.1 External TPM Clock Sources When control bits CLKSB:CLKSA in the timer status and control register are set to 1:1, the prescaler and consequently the 16-bit counter for TPMx are driven by an external clock source, TPMxCLK, connected to an I/O pin. A synchronizer is needed between the external clock and the rest of the TPM. This synchronizer is clocked by the bus clock so the frequency of the external source must be less than one-half the frequency of the bus rate clock. The upper frequency limit for this external clock source is specified to be one-fourth the bus frequency to conservatively accommodate duty cycle and phase-locked loop (PLL) or frequency-locked loop (FLL) frequency jitter effects. On some devices the external clock input is shared with one of the TPM channels. When a TPM channel is shared as the external clock input, the associated TPM channel cannot use the pin. (The channel can still be used in output compare mode as a software timer.) Also, if one of the TPM channels is used as the external clock input, the corresponding ELSnB:ELSnA control bits must be set to 0:0 so the channel is not trying to use the same pin. 11.2.2 TPMxCHn — TPMx Channel n I/O Pins Each TPM channel is associated with an I/O pin on the MCU. The function of this pin depends on the configuration of the channel. In some cases, no pin function is needed so the pin reverts to being controlled by general-purpose I/O controls. When a timer has control of a port pin, the port data and data direction registers do not affect the related pin(s). See the Pins and Connections chapter for additional information about shared pin functions. 11.3 Register Definition The TPM includes: • An 8-bit status and control register (TPMxSC) • A 16-bit counter (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL) • A 16-bit modulo register (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL) Each timer channel has: • An 8-bit status and control register (TPMxCnSC) • A 16-bit channel value register (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) Refer to the direct-page register summary in the Memory chapter of this data sheet for the absolute address assignments for all TPM registers. This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 149 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses. 11.3.1 Timer Status and Control Register (TPMxSC) TPMxSC contains the overflow status flag and control bits that are used to configure the interrupt enable, TPM configuration, clock source, and prescale divisor. These controls relate to all channels within this timer module. 7 R 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 TOIE CPWMS CLKSB CLKSA PS2 PS1 PS0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 TOF W Reset 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 11-3. Timer Status and Control Register (TPMxSC) Table 11-1. TPMxSC Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 TOF Timer Overflow Flag — This flag is set when the TPM counter changes to 0x0000 after reaching the modulo value programmed in the TPM counter modulo registers. When the TPM is configured for CPWM, TOF is set after the counter has reached the value in the modulo register, at the transition to the next lower count value. Clear TOF by reading the TPM status and control register when TOF is set and then writing a 0 to TOF. If another TPM overflow occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, the sequence is reset so TOF would remain set after the clear sequence was completed for the earlier TOF. Reset clears TOF. Writing a 1 to TOF has no effect. 0 TPM counter has not reached modulo value or overflow 1 TPM counter has overflowed 6 TOIE Timer Overflow Interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables TPM overflow interrupts. If TOIE is set, an interrupt is generated when TOF equals 1. Reset clears TOIE. 0 TOF interrupts inhibited (use software polling) 1 TOF interrupts enabled 5 CPWMS Center-Aligned PWM Select — This read/write bit selects CPWM operating mode. Reset clears this bit so the TPM operates in up-counting mode for input capture, output compare, and edge-aligned PWM functions. Setting CPWMS reconfigures the TPM to operate in up-/down-counting mode for CPWM functions. Reset clears CPWMS. 0 All TPMx channels operate as input capture, output compare, or edge-aligned PWM mode as selected by the MSnB:MSnA control bits in each channel’s status and control register 1 All TPMx channels operate in center-aligned PWM mode 4:3 CLKS[B:A] Clock Source Select — As shown in Table 11-2, this 2-bit field is used to disable the TPM system or select one of three clock sources to drive the counter prescaler. The external source and the XCLK are synchronized to the bus clock by an on-chip synchronization circuit. 2:0 PS[2:0] Prescale Divisor Select — This 3-bit field selects one of eight divisors for the TPM clock input as shown in Table 11-3. This prescaler is located after any clock source synchronization or clock source selection, so it affects whatever clock source is selected to drive the TPM system. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 150 Freescale Semiconductor Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) Table 11-2. TPM Clock Source Selection CLKSB:CLKSA TPM Clock Source to Prescaler Input 0:0 No clock selected (TPMx disabled) 0:1 Bus rate clock (BUSCLK) 1:0 Fixed system clock (XCLK) 1:1 External source (TPMxCLK)1,2 1 The maximum frequency that is allowed as an external clock is one-fourth of the bus frequency. 2 If the external clock input is shared with channel n and is selected as the TPM clock source, the corresponding ELSnB:ELSnA control bits must be set to 0:0 so channel n does not try to use the same pin for a conflicting function. Table 11-3. Prescale Divisor Selection 11.3.2 PS2:PS1:PS0 TPM Clock Source Divided-By 0:0:0 1 0:0:1 2 0:1:0 4 0:1:1 8 1:0:0 16 1:0:1 32 1:1:0 64 1:1:1 128 Timer Counter Registers (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL) The two read-only TPM counter registers contain the high and low bytes of the value in the TPM counter. Reading either byte (TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL) latches the contents of both bytes into a buffer where they remain latched until the other byte is read. This allows coherent 16-bit reads in either order. The coherency mechanism is automatically restarted by an MCU reset, a write of any value to TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL, or any write to the timer status/control register (TPMxSC). Reset clears the TPM counter registers. R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 W Reset Any write to TPMxCNTH clears the 16-bit counter. 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 11-4. Timer Counter Register High (TPMxCNTH) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 151 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 W Reset Any write to TPMxCNTL clears the 16-bit counter. 0 0 0 0 0 0 Figure 11-5. Timer Counter Register Low (TPMxCNTL) When background mode is active, the timer counter and the coherency mechanism are frozen such that the buffer latches remain in the state they were in when the background mode became active even if one or both bytes of the counter are read while background mode is active. 11.3.3 Timer Counter Modulo Registers (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL) The read/write TPM modulo registers contain the modulo value for the TPM counter. After the TPM counter reaches the modulo value, the TPM counter resumes counting from 0x0000 at the next clock (CPWMS = 0) or starts counting down (CPWMS = 1), and the overflow flag (TOF) becomes set. Writing to TPMxMODH or TPMxMODL inhibits TOF and overflow interrupts until the other byte is written. Reset sets the TPM counter modulo registers to 0x0000, which results in a free-running timer counter (modulo disabled). 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset Figure 11-6. Timer Counter Modulo Register High (TPMxMODH) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset Figure 11-7. Timer Counter Modulo Register Low (TPMxMODL) It is good practice to wait for an overflow interrupt so both bytes of the modulo register can be written well before a new overflow. An alternative approach is to reset the TPM counter before writing to the TPM modulo registers to avoid confusion about when the first counter overflow will occur. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 152 Freescale Semiconductor Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) 11.3.4 Timer Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC) TPMxCnSC contains the channel interrupt status flag and control bits that are used to configure the interrupt enable, channel configuration, and pin function. 7 6 5 4 3 2 CHnF CHnIE MSnB MSnA ELSnB ELSnA 0 0 0 0 0 0 R 1 0 0 0 0 0 W Reset = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 11-8. Timer Channel n Status and Control Register (TPMxCnSC) Table 11-4. TPMxCnSC Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 CHnF Channel n Flag — When channel n is configured for input capture, this flag bit is set when an active edge occurs on the channel n pin. When channel n is an output compare or edge-aligned PWM channel, CHnF is set when the value in the TPM counter registers matches the value in the TPM channel n value registers. This flag is seldom used with center-aligned PWMs because it is set every time the counter matches the channel value register, which correspond to both edges of the active duty cycle period. A corresponding interrupt is requested when CHnF is set and interrupts are enabled (CHnIE = 1). Clear CHnF by reading TPMxCnSC while CHnF is set and then writing a 0 to CHnF. If another interrupt request occurs before the clearing sequence is complete, the sequence is reset so CHnF would remain set after the clear sequence was completed for the earlier CHnF. This is done so a CHnF interrupt request cannot be lost by clearing a previous CHnF. Reset clears CHnF. Writing a 1 to CHnF has no effect. 0 No input capture or output compare event occurred on channel n 1 Input capture or output compare event occurred on channel n 6 CHnIE Channel n Interrupt Enable — This read/write bit enables interrupts from channel n. Reset clears CHnIE. 0 Channel n interrupt requests disabled (use software polling) 1 Channel n interrupt requests enabled 5 MSnB Mode Select B for TPM Channel n — When CPWMS = 0, MSnB = 1 configures TPM channel n for edge-aligned PWM mode. For a summary of channel mode and setup controls, refer to Table 11-5. 4 MSnA Mode Select A for TPM Channel n — When CPWMS = 0 and MSnB = 0, MSnA configures TPM channel n for input capture mode or output compare mode. Refer to Table 11-5 for a summary of channel mode and setup controls. 3:2 ELSn[B:A] Edge/Level Select Bits — Depending on the operating mode for the timer channel as set by CPWMS:MSnB:MSnA and shown in Table 11-5, these bits select the polarity of the input edge that triggers an input capture event, select the level that will be driven in response to an output compare match, or select the polarity of the PWM output. Setting ELSnB:ELSnA to 0:0 configures the related timer pin as a general-purpose I/O pin unrelated to any timer channel functions. This function is typically used to temporarily disable an input capture channel or to make the timer pin available as a general-purpose I/O pin when the associated timer channel is set up as a software timer that does not require the use of a pin. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 153 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) Table 11-5. Mode, Edge, and Level Selection CPWMS MSnB:MSnA ELSnB:ELSnA X XX 00 0 00 01 01 Input capture Capture on falling edge only 11 Capture on rising or falling edge 00 Output compare Software compare only Toggle output on compare 10 Clear output on compare 11 Set output on compare 10 XX Capture on rising edge only 10 Edge-aligned PWM X1 1 Configuration Pin not used for TPM channel; use as an external clock for the TPM or revert to general-purpose I/O 01 1X Mode 10 Center-aligned PWM X1 High-true pulses (clear output on compare) Low-true pulses (set output on compare) High-true pulses (clear output on compare-up) Low-true pulses (set output on compare-up) If the associated port pin is not stable for at least two bus clock cycles before changing to input capture mode, it is possible to get an unexpected indication of an edge trigger. Typically, a program would clear status flags after changing channel configuration bits and before enabling channel interrupts or using the status flags to avoid any unexpected behavior. 11.3.5 Timer Channel Value Registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) These read/write registers contain the captured TPM counter value of the input capture function or the output compare value for the output compare or PWM functions. The channel value registers are cleared by reset. 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 Bit 8 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset Figure 11-9. Timer Channel Value Register High (TPMxCnVH) 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 Bit 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 Bit 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 R W Reset Figure 11-10. Timer Channel Value Register Low (TPMxCnVL) In input capture mode, reading either byte (TPMxCnVH or TPMxCnVL) latches the contents of both bytes into a buffer where they remain latched until the other byte is read. This latching mechanism also resets (becomes unlatched) when the TPMxCnSC register is written. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 154 Freescale Semiconductor Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) In output compare or PWM modes, writing to either byte (TPMxCnVH or TPMxCnVL) latches the value into a buffer. When both bytes have been written, they are transferred as a coherent 16-bit value into the timer channel value registers. This latching mechanism may be manually reset by writing to the TPMxCnSC register. This latching mechanism allows coherent 16-bit writes in either order, which is friendly to various compiler implementations. 11.4 Functional Description All TPM functions are associated with a main 16-bit counter that allows flexible selection of the clock source and prescale divisor. A 16-bit modulo register also is associated with the main 16-bit counter in the TPM. Each TPM channel is optionally associated with an MCU pin and a maskable interrupt function. The TPM has center-aligned PWM capabilities controlled by the CPWMS control bit in TPMxSC. When CPWMS is set to 1, timer counter TPMxCNT changes to an up-/down-counter and all channels in the associated TPM act as center-aligned PWM channels. When CPWMS = 0, each channel can independently be configured to operate in input capture, output compare, or buffered edge-aligned PWM mode. The following sections describe the main 16-bit counter and each of the timer operating modes (input capture, output compare, edge-aligned PWM, and center-aligned PWM). Because details of pin operation and interrupt activity depend on the operating mode, these topics are covered in the associated mode sections. 11.4.1 Counter All timer functions are based on the main 16-bit counter (TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL). This section discusses selection of the clock source, up-counting vs. up-/down-counting, end-of-count overflow, and manual counter reset. After any MCU reset, CLKSB:CLKSA = 0:0 so no clock source is selected and the TPM is inactive. Normally, CLKSB:CLKSA would be set to 0:1 so the bus clock drives the timer counter. The clock source for the TPM can be selected to be off, the bus clock (BUSCLK), the fixed system clock (XCLK), or an external input. The maximum frequency allowed for the external clock option is one-fourth the bus rate. Refer to Section 11.3.1, “Timer Status and Control Register (TPMxSC)” and Table 11-2 for more information about clock source selection. When the microcontroller is in active background mode, the TPM temporarily suspends all counting until the microcontroller returns to normal user operating mode. During stop mode, all TPM clocks are stopped; therefore, the TPM is effectively disabled until clocks resume. During wait mode, the TPM continues to operate normally. The main 16-bit counter has two counting modes. When center-aligned PWM is selected (CPWMS = 1), the counter operates in up-/down-counting mode. Otherwise, the counter operates as a simple up-counter. As an up-counter, the main 16-bit counter counts from 0x0000 through its terminal count and then continues with 0x0000. The terminal count is 0xFFFF or a modulus value in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 155 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) When center-aligned PWM operation is specified, the counter counts upward from 0x0000 through its terminal count and then counts downward to 0x0000 where it returns to up-counting. Both 0x0000 and the terminal count value (value in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL) are normal length counts (one timer clock period long). An interrupt flag and enable are associated with the main 16-bit counter. The timer overflow flag (TOF) is a software-accessible indication that the timer counter has overflowed. The enable signal selects between software polling (TOIE = 0) where no hardware interrupt is generated, or interrupt-driven operation (TOIE = 1) where a static hardware interrupt is automatically generated whenever the TOF flag is 1. The conditions that cause TOF to become set depend on the counting mode (up or up/down). In up-counting mode, the main 16-bit counter counts from 0x0000 through 0xFFFF and overflows to 0x0000 on the next counting clock. TOF becomes set at the transition from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. When a modulus limit is set, TOF becomes set at the transition from the value set in the modulus register to 0x0000. When the main 16-bit counter is operating in up-/down-counting mode, the TOF flag gets set as the counter changes direction at the transition from the value set in the modulus register and the next lower count value. This corresponds to the end of a PWM period. (The 0x0000 count value corresponds to the center of a period.) Because the HCS08 MCU is an 8-bit architecture, a coherency mechanism is built into the timer counter for read operations. Whenever either byte of the counter is read (TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL), both bytes are captured into a buffer so when the other byte is read, the value will represent the other byte of the count at the time the first byte was read. The counter continues to count normally, but no new value can be read from either byte until both bytes of the old count have been read. The main timer counter can be reset manually at any time by writing any value to either byte of the timer count TPMxCNTH or TPMxCNTL. Resetting the counter in this manner also resets the coherency mechanism in case only one byte of the counter was read before resetting the count. 11.4.2 Channel Mode Selection Provided CPWMS = 0 (center-aligned PWM operation is not specified), the MSnB and MSnA control bits in the channel n status and control registers determine the basic mode of operation for the corresponding channel. Choices include input capture, output compare, and buffered edge-aligned PWM. 11.4.2.1 Input Capture Mode With the input capture function, the TPM can capture the time at which an external event occurs. When an active edge occurs on the pin of an input capture channel, the TPM latches the contents of the TPM counter into the channel value registers (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL). Rising edges, falling edges, or any edge may be chosen as the active edge that triggers an input capture. When either byte of the 16-bit capture register is read, both bytes are latched into a buffer to support coherent 16-bit accesses regardless of order. The coherency sequence can be manually reset by writing to the channel status/control register (TPMxCnSC). An input capture event sets a flag bit (CHnF) that can optionally generate a CPU interrupt request. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 156 Freescale Semiconductor Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) 11.4.2.2 Output Compare Mode With the output compare function, the TPM can generate timed pulses with programmable position, polarity, duration, and frequency. When the counter reaches the value in the channel value registers of an output compare channel, the TPM can set, clear, or toggle the channel pin. In output compare mode, values are transferred to the corresponding timer channel value registers only after both 8-bit bytes of a 16-bit register have been written. This coherency sequence can be manually reset by writing to the channel status/control register (TPMxCnSC). An output compare event sets a flag bit (CHnF) that can optionally generate a CPU interrupt request. 11.4.2.3 Edge-Aligned PWM Mode This type of PWM output uses the normal up-counting mode of the timer counter (CPWMS = 0) and can be used when other channels in the same TPM are configured for input capture or output compare functions. The period of this PWM signal is determined by the setting in the modulus register (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL). The duty cycle is determined by the setting in the timer channel value register (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL). The polarity of this PWM signal is determined by the setting in the ELSnA control bit. Duty cycle cases of 0 percent and 100 percent are possible. As Figure 11-11 shows, the output compare value in the TPM channel registers determines the pulse width (duty cycle) of the PWM signal. The time between the modulus overflow and the output compare is the pulse width. If ELSnA = 0, the counter overflow forces the PWM signal high and the output compare forces the PWM signal low. If ELSnA = 1, the counter overflow forces the PWM signal low and the output compare forces the PWM signal high. OVERFLOW OVERFLOW OVERFLOW PERIOD PULSE WIDTH TPMxC OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE OUTPUT COMPARE Figure 11-11. PWM Period and Pulse Width (ELSnA = 0) When the channel value register is set to 0x0000, the duty cycle is 0 percent. By setting the timer channel value register (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) to a value greater than the modulus setting, 100% duty cycle can be achieved. This implies that the modulus setting must be less than 0xFFFF to get 100% duty cycle. Because the HCS08 is a family of 8-bit MCUs, the settings in the timer channel registers are buffered to ensure coherent 16-bit updates and to avoid unexpected PWM pulse widths. Writes to either register, TPMxCnVH or TPMxCnVL, write to buffer registers. In edge-PWM mode, values are transferred to the corresponding timer channel registers only after both 8-bit bytes of a 16-bit register have been written and the value in the TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL counter is 0x0000. (The new duty cycle does not take effect until the next full period.) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 157 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) 11.4.3 Center-Aligned PWM Mode This type of PWM output uses the up-/down-counting mode of the timer counter (CPWMS = 1). The output compare value in TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL determines the pulse width (duty cycle) of the PWM signal and the period is determined by the value in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL. TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL must be kept in the range of 0x0001 to 0x7FFF because values outside this range can produce ambiguous results. ELSnA will determine the polarity of the CPWM output. pulse width = 2 x (TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL) Eqn. 11-1 period = 2 x (TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL); for TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0001–0x7FFF Eqn. 11-2 If the channel value register TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL is zero or negative (bit 15 set), the duty cycle will be 0%. If TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL is a positive value (bit 15 clear) and is greater than the (nonzero) modulus setting, the duty cycle will be 100% because the duty cycle compare will never occur. This implies the usable range of periods set by the modulus register is 0x0001 through 0x7FFE (0x7FFF if generation of 100% duty cycle is not necessary). This is not a significant limitation because the resulting period is much longer than required for normal applications. TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL = 0x0000 is a special case that must not be used with center-aligned PWM mode. When CPWMS = 0, this case corresponds to the counter running free from 0x0000 through 0xFFFF, but when CPWMS = 1 the counter needs a valid match to the modulus register somewhere other than at 0x0000 in order to change directions from up-counting to down-counting. Figure 11-12 shows the output compare value in the TPM channel registers (multiplied by 2), which determines the pulse width (duty cycle) of the CPWM signal. If ELSnA = 0, the compare match while counting up forces the CPWM output signal low and a compare match while counting down forces the output high. The counter counts up until it reaches the modulo setting in TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, then counts down until it reaches zero. This sets the period equal to two times TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL. COUNT = TPMxMODH:TPMx OUTPUT COMPARE (COUNT DOWN) COUNT = 0 OUTPUT COMPARE (COUNT UP) COUNT = TPMxMODH:TPMx TPM1C PULSE WIDTH 2x 2x PERIOD Figure 11-12. CPWM Period and Pulse Width (ELSnA = 0) Center-aligned PWM outputs typically produce less noise than edge-aligned PWMs because fewer I/O pin transitions are lined up at the same system clock edge. This type of PWM is also required for some types of motor drives. Because the HCS08 is a family of 8-bit MCUs, the settings in the timer channel registers are buffered to ensure coherent 16-bit updates and to avoid unexpected PWM pulse widths. Writes to any of the registers, TPMxMODH, TPMxMODL, TPMxCnVH, and TPMxCnVL, actually write to buffer registers. Values are MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 158 Freescale Semiconductor Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) transferred to the corresponding timer channel registers only after both 8-bit bytes of a 16-bit register have been written and the timer counter overflows (reverses direction from up-counting to down-counting at the end of the terminal count in the modulus register). This TPMxCNT overflow requirement only applies to PWM channels, not output compares. Optionally, when TPMxCNTH:TPMxCNTL = TPMxMODH:TPMxMODL, the TPM can generate a TOF interrupt at the end of this count. The user can choose to reload any number of the PWM buffers, and they will all update simultaneously at the start of a new period. Writing to TPMxSC cancels any values written to TPMxMODH and/or TPMxMODL and resets the coherency mechanism for the modulo registers. Writing to TPMxCnSC cancels any values written to the channel value registers and resets the coherency mechanism for TPMxCnVH:TPMxCnVL. 11.5 TPM Interrupts The TPM generates an optional interrupt for the main counter overflow and an interrupt for each channel. The meaning of channel interrupts depends on the mode of operation for each channel. If the channel is configured for input capture, the interrupt flag is set each time the selected input capture edge is recognized. If the channel is configured for output compare or PWM modes, the interrupt flag is set each time the main timer counter matches the value in the 16-bit channel value register. See the Resets, Interrupts, and System Configuration chapter for absolute interrupt vector addresses, priority, and local interrupt mask control bits. For each interrupt source in the TPM, a flag bit is set on recognition of the interrupt condition such as timer overflow, channel input capture, or output compare events. This flag may be read (polled) by software to verify that the action has occurred, or an associated enable bit (TOIE or CHnIE) can be set to enable hardware interrupt generation. While the interrupt enable bit is set, a static interrupt will be generated whenever the associated interrupt flag equals 1. It is the responsibility of user software to perform a sequence of steps to clear the interrupt flag before returning from the interrupt service routine. 11.5.1 Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags TPM interrupt flags are cleared by a 2-step process that includes a read of the flag bit while it is set (1) followed by a write of 0 to the bit. If a new event is detected between these two steps, the sequence is reset and the interrupt flag remains set after the second step to avoid the possibility of missing the new event. 11.5.2 Timer Overflow Interrupt Description The conditions that cause TOF to become set depend on the counting mode (up or up/down). In up-counting mode, the 16-bit timer counter counts from 0x0000 through 0xFFFF and overflows to 0x0000 on the next counting clock. TOF becomes set at the transition from 0xFFFF to 0x0000. When a modulus limit is set, TOF becomes set at the transition from the value set in the modulus register to 0x0000. When the counter is operating in up-/down-counting mode, the TOF flag gets set as the counter changes direction at the transition from the value set in the modulus register and the next lower count value. This corresponds to the end of a PWM period. (The 0x0000 count value corresponds to the center of a period.) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 159 Timer/Pulse-Width Modulator (S08TPMV2) 11.5.3 Channel Event Interrupt Description The meaning of channel interrupts depends on the current mode of the channel (input capture, output compare, edge-aligned PWM, or center-aligned PWM). When a channel is configured as an input capture channel, the ELSnB:ELSnA control bits select rising edges, falling edges, any edge, or no edge (off) as the edge that triggers an input capture event. When the selected edge is detected, the interrupt flag is set. The flag is cleared by the 2-step sequence described in Section 11.5.1, “Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags.” When a channel is configured as an output compare channel, the interrupt flag is set each time the main timer counter matches the 16-bit value in the channel value register. The flag is cleared by the 2-step sequence described in Section 11.5.1, “Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags.” 11.5.4 PWM End-of-Duty-Cycle Events For channels that are configured for PWM operation, there are two possibilities: • When the channel is configured for edge-aligned PWM, the channel flag is set when the timer counter matches the channel value register that marks the end of the active duty cycle period. • When the channel is configured for center-aligned PWM, the timer count matches the channel value register twice during each PWM cycle. In this CPWM case, the channel flag is set at the start and at the end of the active duty cycle, which are the times when the timer counter matches the channel value register. The flag is cleared by the 2-step sequence described in Section 11.5.1, “Clearing Timer Interrupt Flags.” MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 160 Freescale Semiconductor Chapter 12 Development Support 12.1 Introduction Development support systems in the HCS08 include the background debug controller (BDC). The BDC provides a single-wire debug interface to the target MCU that provides a convenient interface for programming the on-chip flash and other nonvolatile memories. The BDC is also the primary debug interface for development and allows non-intrusive access to memory data and traditional debug features such as CPU register modify, breakpoints, and single instruction trace commands. In the HCS08 Family, address and data bus signals are not available on external pins (not even in test modes). Debug is done through commands fed into the target MCU via the single-wire background debug interface. The debug module provides a means to selectively trigger and capture bus information so an external development system can reconstruct what happened inside the MCU on a cycle-by-cycle basis without having external access to the address and data signals. 12.1.1 Forcing Active Background The method for forcing active background mode depends on the specific HCS08 derivative. For the MC9S08QD4 series, you can force active background mode by holding the BKGD pin low as the MCU exits the reset condition independent of what caused the reset. If no debug pod is connected to the BKGD pin, the MCU will always reset into normal operating mode. 12.1.2 Module Configuration The alternative BDC clock source for MC9S08QD4 series is the ICGCLK. See Chapter 9, “Internal Clock Source (S08ICSV1),” for more information about ICGCLK and how to select clock sources. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 161 Development Support 12.1.3 Features Features of the BDC module include: • Single pin for mode selection and background communications • BDC registers are not located in the memory map • SYNC command to determine target communications rate • Non-intrusive commands for memory access • Active background mode commands for CPU register access • GO and TRACE1 commands • BACKGROUND command can wake CPU from stop or wait modes • One hardware address breakpoint built into BDC • Oscillator runs in stop mode, if BDC enabled • COP watchdog disabled while in active background mode 12.2 Background Debug Controller (BDC) All MCUs in the HCS08 Family contain a single-wire background debug interface that supports in-circuit programming of on-chip nonvolatile memory and sophisticated non-intrusive debug capabilities. Unlike debug interfaces on earlier 8-bit MCUs, this system does not interfere with normal application resources. It does not use any user memory or locations in the memory map and does not share any on-chip peripherals. BDC commands are divided into two groups: • Active background mode commands require that the target MCU is in active background mode (the user program is not running). Active background mode commands allow the CPU registers to be read or written, and allow the user to trace one user instruction at a time, or GO to the user program from active background mode. • Non-intrusive commands can be executed at any time even while the user’s program is running. Non-intrusive commands allow a user to read or write MCU memory locations or access status and control registers within the background debug controller. Typically, a relatively simple interface pod is used to translate commands from a host computer into commands for the custom serial interface to the single-wire background debug system. Depending on the development tool vendor, this interface pod may use a standard RS-232 serial port, a parallel printer port, or some other type of communications such as a universal serial bus (USB) to communicate between the host PC and the pod. The pod typically connects to the target system with ground, the BKGD pin, RESET, and sometimes VDD. An open-drain connection to reset allows the host to force a target system reset, which is useful to regain control of a lost target system or to control startup of a target system before the on-chip nonvolatile memory has been programmed. Sometimes VDD can be used to allow the pod to use power from the target system to avoid the need for a separate power supply. However, if the pod is powered separately, it can be connected to a running target system without forcing a target system reset or otherwise disturbing the running application program. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 162 Freescale Semiconductor Development Support BKGD 1 2 GND NO CONNECT 3 4 RESET NO CONNECT 5 6 VDD Figure 12-1. BDM Tool Connector 12.2.1 BKGD Pin Description BKGD is the single-wire background debug interface pin. The primary function of this pin is for bidirectional serial communication of active background mode commands and data. During reset, this pin is used to select between starting in active background mode or starting the user’s application program. This pin is also used to request a timed sync response pulse to allow a host development tool to determine the correct clock frequency for background debug serial communications. BDC serial communications use a custom serial protocol first introduced on the M68HC12 Family of microcontrollers. This protocol assumes the host knows the communication clock rate that is determined by the target BDC clock rate. All communication is initiated and controlled by the host that drives a high-to-low edge to signal the beginning of each bit time. Commands and data are sent most significant bit first (MSB first). For a detailed description of the communications protocol, refer to Section 12.2.2, “Communication Details.” If a host is attempting to communicate with a target MCU that has an unknown BDC clock rate, a SYNC command may be sent to the target MCU to request a timed sync response signal from which the host can determine the correct communication speed. BKGD is a pseudo-open-drain pin and there is an on-chip pullup so no external pullup resistor is required. Unlike typical open-drain pins, the external RC time constant on this pin, which is influenced by external capacitance, plays almost no role in signal rise time. The custom protocol provides for brief, actively driven speedup pulses to force rapid rise times on this pin without risking harmful drive level conflicts. Refer to Section 12.2.2, “Communication Details,” for more detail. When no debugger pod is connected to the 6-pin BDM interface connector, the internal pullup on BKGD chooses normal operating mode. When a debug pod is connected to BKGD it is possible to force the MCU into active background mode after reset. The specific conditions for forcing active background depend upon the HCS08 derivative (refer to the introduction to this Development Support section). It is not necessary to reset the target MCU to communicate with it through the background debug interface. 12.2.2 Communication Details The BDC serial interface requires the external controller to generate a falling edge on the BKGD pin to indicate the start of each bit time. The external controller provides this falling edge whether data is transmitted or received. BKGD is a pseudo-open-drain pin that can be driven either by an external controller or by the MCU. Data is transferred MSB first at 16 BDC clock cycles per bit (nominal speed). The interface times out if 512 BDC clock cycles occur between falling edges from the host. Any BDC command that was in progress MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 163 Development Support when this timeout occurs is aborted without affecting the memory or operating mode of the target MCU system. The custom serial protocol requires the debug pod to know the target BDC communication clock speed. The clock switch (CLKSW) control bit in the BDC status and control register allows the user to select the BDC clock source. The BDC clock source can either be the bus or the alternate BDC clock source. The BKGD pin can receive a high or low level or transmit a high or low level. The following diagrams show timing for each of these cases. Interface timing is synchronous to clocks in the target BDC, but asynchronous to the external host. The internal BDC clock signal is shown for reference in counting cycles. Figure 12-2 shows an external host transmitting a logic 1 or 0 to the BKGD pin of a target HCS08 MCU. The host is asynchronous to the target so there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge to where the target perceives the beginning of the bit time. Ten target BDC clock cycles later, the target senses the bit level on the BKGD pin. Typically, the host actively drives the pseudo-open-drain BKGD pin during host-to-target transmissions to speed up rising edges. Because the target does not drive the BKGD pin during the host-to-target transmission period, there is no need to treat the line as an open-drain signal during this period. BDC CLOCK (TARGET MCU) HOST TRANSMIT 1 HOST TRANSMIT 0 10 CYCLES SYNCHRONIZATION UNCERTAINTY EARLIEST START OF NEXT BIT TARGET SENSES BIT LEVEL PERCEIVED START OF BIT TIME Figure 12-2. BDC Host-to-Target Serial Bit Timing Figure 12-3 shows the host receiving a logic 1 from the target HCS08 MCU. Because the host is asynchronous to the target MCU, there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge on BKGD to the perceived start of the bit time in the target MCU. The host holds the BKGD pin low long enough for the target to recognize it (at least two target BDC cycles). The host must release the low drive before the target MCU drives a brief active-high speedup pulse seven cycles after the perceived start of the bit time. The host must sample the bit level about 10 cycles after it started the bit time. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 164 Freescale Semiconductor Development Support BDC CLOCK (TARGET MCU) HOST DRIVE TO BKGD PIN TARGET MCU SPEEDUP PULSE HIGH-IMPEDANCE HIGH-IMPEDANCE HIGH-IMPEDANCE PERCEIVED START OF BIT TIME R-C RISE BKGD PIN 10 CYCLES 10 CYCLES EARLIEST START OF NEXT BIT HOST SAMPLES BKGD PIN Figure 12-3. BDC Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 1) Figure 12-4 shows the host receiving a logic 0 from the target HCS08 MCU. Because the host is asynchronous to the target MCU, there is a 0-to-1 cycle delay from the host-generated falling edge on BKGD to the start of the bit time as perceived by the target MCU. The host initiates the bit time but the target HCS08 finishes it. Because the target wants the host to receive a logic 0, it drives the BKGD pin low for 13 BDC clock cycles, then briefly drives it high to speed up the rising edge. The host samples the bit level about 10 cycles after starting the bit time. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 165 Development Support BDC CLOCK (TARGET MCU) HOST DRIVE TO BKGD PIN HIGH-IMPEDANCE SPEEDUP PULSE TARGET MCU DRIVE AND SPEED-UP PULSE PERCEIVED START OF BIT TIME BKGD PIN 10 CYCLES 10 CYCLES EARLIEST START OF NEXT BIT HOST SAMPLES BKGD PIN Figure 12-4. BDM Target-to-Host Serial Bit Timing (Logic 0) 12.2.3 BDC Commands BDC commands are sent serially from a host computer to the BKGD pin of the target HCS08 MCU. All commands and data are sent MSB-first using a custom BDC communications protocol. Active background mode commands require that the target MCU is currently in the active background mode while non-intrusive commands may be issued at any time whether the target MCU is in active background mode or running a user application program. Table 12-1 shows all HCS08 BDC commands, a shorthand description of their coding structure, and the meaning of each command. Coding Structure Nomenclature This nomenclature is used in Table 12-1 to describe the coding structure of the BDC commands. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 166 Freescale Semiconductor Development Support / d AAAA RD WD RD16 WD16 SS CC RBKP = = = = = = = = = = WBKP = Commands begin with an 8-bit hexadecimal command code in the host-to-target direction (most significant bit first) separates parts of the command delay 16 target BDC clock cycles a 16-bit address in the host-to-target direction 8 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction 8 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction 16 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction 16 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction the contents of BDCSCR in the target-to-host direction (STATUS) 8 bits of write data for BDCSCR in the host-to-target direction (CONTROL) 16 bits of read data in the target-to-host direction (from BDCBKPT breakpoint register) 16 bits of write data in the host-to-target direction (for BDCBKPT breakpoint register) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 167 Development Support Table 12-1. BDC Command Summary Command Mnemonic 1 Active BDM/ Non-intrusive Coding Structure Description SYNC Non-intrusive n/a1 Request a timed reference pulse to determine target BDC communication speed ACK_ENABLE Non-intrusive D5/d Enable acknowledge protocol. Refer to Freescale document order no. HCS08RMv1/D. ACK_DISABLE Non-intrusive D6/d Disable acknowledge protocol. Refer to Freescale document order no. HCS08RMv1/D. BACKGROUND Non-intrusive 90/d Enter active background mode if enabled (ignore if ENBDM bit equals 0) READ_STATUS Non-intrusive E4/SS Read BDC status from BDCSCR WRITE_CONTROL Non-intrusive C4/CC Write BDC controls in BDCSCR READ_BYTE Non-intrusive E0/AAAA/d/RD Read a byte from target memory READ_BYTE_WS Non-intrusive E1/AAAA/d/SS/RD Read a byte and report status READ_LAST Non-intrusive E8/SS/RD Re-read byte from address just read and report status WRITE_BYTE Non-intrusive C0/AAAA/WD/d Write a byte to target memory WRITE_BYTE_WS Non-intrusive C1/AAAA/WD/d/SS Write a byte and report status READ_BKPT Non-intrusive E2/RBKP Read BDCBKPT breakpoint register WRITE_BKPT Non-intrusive C2/WBKP Write BDCBKPT breakpoint register GO Active BDM 08/d Go to execute the user application program starting at the address currently in the PC TRACE1 Active BDM 10/d Trace 1 user instruction at the address in the PC, then return to active background mode TAGGO Active BDM 18/d Same as GO but enable external tagging (HCS08 devices have no external tagging pin) READ_A Active BDM 68/d/RD Read accumulator (A) READ_CCR Active BDM 69/d/RD Read condition code register (CCR) READ_PC Active BDM 6B/d/RD16 Read program counter (PC) READ_HX Active BDM 6C/d/RD16 Read H and X register pair (H:X) READ_SP Active BDM 6F/d/RD16 Read stack pointer (SP) READ_NEXT Active BDM 70/d/RD Increment H:X by one then read memory byte located at H:X READ_NEXT_WS Active BDM 71/d/SS/RD Increment H:X by one then read memory byte located at H:X. Report status and data. WRITE_A Active BDM 48/WD/d Write accumulator (A) WRITE_CCR Active BDM 49/WD/d Write condition code register (CCR) WRITE_PC Active BDM 4B/WD16/d Write program counter (PC) WRITE_HX Active BDM 4C/WD16/d Write H and X register pair (H:X) WRITE_SP Active BDM 4F/WD16/d Write stack pointer (SP) WRITE_NEXT Active BDM 50/WD/d Increment H:X by one, then write memory byte located at H:X WRITE_NEXT_WS Active BDM 51/WD/d/SS Increment H:X by one, then write memory byte located at H:X. Also report status. The SYNC command is a special operation that does not have a command code. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 168 Freescale Semiconductor Development Support The SYNC command is unlike other BDC commands because the host does not necessarily know the correct communications speed to use for BDC communications until after it has analyzed the response to the SYNC command. To issue a SYNC command, the host: • Drives the BKGD pin low for at least 128 cycles of the slowest possible BDC clock (The slowest clock is normally the reference oscillator/64 or the self-clocked rate/64.) • Drives BKGD high for a brief speedup pulse to get a fast rise time (This speedup pulse is typically one cycle of the fastest clock in the system.) • Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance • Monitors the BKGD pin for the sync response pulse The target, upon detecting the SYNC request from the host (which is a much longer low time than would ever occur during normal BDC communications): • Waits for BKGD to return to a logic high • Delays 16 cycles to allow the host to stop driving the high speedup pulse • Drives BKGD low for 128 BDC clock cycles • Drives a 1-cycle high speedup pulse to force a fast rise time on BKGD • Removes all drive to the BKGD pin so it reverts to high impedance The host measures the low time of this 128-cycle sync response pulse and determines the correct speed for subsequent BDC communications. Typically, the host can determine the correct communication speed within a few percent of the actual target speed and the communication protocol can easily tolerate speed errors of several percent. 12.2.4 BDC Hardware Breakpoint The BDC includes one relatively simple hardware breakpoint that compares the CPU address bus to a 16-bit match value in the BDCBKPT register. This breakpoint can generate a forced breakpoint or a tagged breakpoint. A forced breakpoint causes the CPU to enter active background mode at the first instruction boundary following any access to the breakpoint address. The tagged breakpoint causes the instruction opcode at the breakpoint address to be tagged so that the CPU will enter active background mode rather than executing that instruction if and when it reaches the end of the instruction queue. This implies that tagged breakpoints can only be placed at the address of an instruction opcode while forced breakpoints can be set at any address. The breakpoint enable (BKPTEN) control bit in the BDC status and control register (BDCSCR) is used to enable the breakpoint logic (BKPTEN = 1). When BKPTEN = 0, its default value after reset, the breakpoint logic is disabled and no BDC breakpoints are requested regardless of the values in other BDC breakpoint registers and control bits. The force/tag select (FTS) control bit in BDCSCR is used to select forced (FTS = 1) or tagged (FTS = 0) type breakpoints. 12.3 Register Definition This section contains the descriptions of the BDC registers and control bits. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 169 Development Support This section refers to registers and control bits only by their names. A Freescale-provided equate or header file is used to translate these names into the appropriate absolute addresses. 12.3.1 BDC Registers and Control Bits The BDC has two registers: • The BDC status and control register (BDCSCR) is an 8-bit register containing control and status bits for the background debug controller. • The BDC breakpoint match register (BDCBKPT) holds a 16-bit breakpoint match address. These registers are accessed with dedicated serial BDC commands and are not located in the memory space of the target MCU (so they do not have addresses and cannot be accessed by user programs). Some of the bits in the BDCSCR have write limitations; otherwise, these registers may be read or written at any time. For example, the ENBDM control bit may not be written while the MCU is in active background mode. (This prevents the ambiguous condition of the control bit forbidding active background mode while the MCU is already in active background mode.) Also, the four status bits (BDMACT, WS, WSF, and DVF) are read-only status indicators and can never be written by the WRITE_CONTROL serial BDC command. The clock switch (CLKSW) control bit may be read or written at any time. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 170 Freescale Semiconductor Development Support 12.3.1.1 BDC Status and Control Register (BDCSCR) This register can be read or written by serial BDC commands (READ_STATUS and WRITE_CONTROL) but is not accessible to user programs because it is not located in the normal memory map of the MCU. 7 R 6 5 4 3 BKPTEN FTS CLKSW BDMACT ENBDM 2 1 0 WS WSF DVF W Normal Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 Reset in Active BDM: 1 1 0 0 1 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved Figure 12-5. BDC Status and Control Register (BDCSCR) Table 12-2. BDCSCR Register Field Descriptions Field Description 7 ENBDM Enable BDM (Permit Active Background Mode) — Typically, this bit is written to 1 by the debug host shortly after the beginning of a debug session or whenever the debug host resets the target and remains 1 until a normal reset clears it. 0 BDM cannot be made active (non-intrusive commands still allowed) 1 BDM can be made active to allow active background mode commands 6 BDMACT Background Mode Active Status — This is a read-only status bit. 0 BDM not active (user application program running) 1 BDM active and waiting for serial commands 5 BKPTEN BDC Breakpoint Enable — If this bit is clear, the BDC breakpoint is disabled and the FTS (force tag select) control bit and BDCBKPT match register are ignored. 0 BDC breakpoint disabled 1 BDC breakpoint enabled 4 FTS Force/Tag Select — When FTS = 1, a breakpoint is requested whenever the CPU address bus matches the BDCBKPT match register. When FTS = 0, a match between the CPU address bus and the BDCBKPT register causes the fetched opcode to be tagged. If this tagged opcode ever reaches the end of the instruction queue, the CPU enters active background mode rather than executing the tagged opcode. 0 Tag opcode at breakpoint address and enter active background mode if CPU attempts to execute that instruction 1 Breakpoint match forces active background mode at next instruction boundary (address need not be an opcode) 3 CLKSW Select Source for BDC Communications Clock — CLKSW defaults to 0, which selects the alternate BDC clock source. 0 Alternate BDC clock source 1 MCU bus clock MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 171 Development Support Table 12-2. BDCSCR Register Field Descriptions (continued) Field Description 2 WS Wait or Stop Status — When the target CPU is in wait or stop mode, most BDC commands cannot function. However, the BACKGROUND command can be used to force the target CPU out of wait or stop and into active background mode where all BDC commands work. Whenever the host forces the target MCU into active background mode, the host must issue a READ_STATUS command to check that BDMACT = 1 before attempting other BDC commands. 0 Target CPU is running user application code or in active background mode (was not in wait or stop mode when background became active) 1 Target CPU is in wait or stop mode, or a BACKGROUND command was used to change from wait or stop to active background mode 1 WSF Wait or Stop Failure Status — This status bit is set if a memory access command failed due to the target CPU executing a wait or stop instruction at or about the same time. The usual recovery strategy is to issue a BACKGROUND command to get out of wait or stop mode into active background mode, repeat the command that failed, then return to the user program. (Typically, the host would restore CPU registers and stack values and re-execute the wait or stop instruction.) 0 Memory access did not conflict with a wait or stop instruction 1 Memory access command failed because the CPU entered wait or stop mode 0 DVF Data Valid Failure Status — This status bit is not used in the MC9S08QD4 series because it does not have any slow access memory. 0 Memory access did not conflict with a slow memory access 1 Memory access command failed because CPU was not finished with a slow memory access 12.3.1.2 BDC Breakpoint Match Register (BDCBKPT) This 16-bit register holds the address for the hardware breakpoint in the BDC. The BKPTEN and FTS control bits in BDCSCR are used to enable and configure the breakpoint logic. Dedicated serial BDC commands (READ_BKPT and WRITE_BKPT) are used to read and write the BDCBKPT register but is not accessible to user programs because it is not located in the normal memory map of the MCU. Breakpoints are normally set while the target MCU is in active background mode before running the user application program. For additional information about setup and use of the hardware breakpoint logic in the BDC, refer to Section 12.2.4, “BDC Hardware Breakpoint.” 12.3.2 System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) This register contains a single write-only control bit. A serial background mode command such as WRITE_BYTE must be used to write to SBDFR. Attempts to write this register from a user program are ignored. Reads always return 0x00. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 172 Freescale Semiconductor Development Support R 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 BDFR1 W Reset 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0 = Unimplemented or Reserved 1 BDFR is writable only through serial background mode debug commands, not from user programs. Figure 12-6. System Background Debug Force Reset Register (SBDFR) Table 12-3. SBDFR Register Field Description Field Description 0 BDFR Background Debug Force Reset — A serial active background mode command such as WRITE_BYTE allows an external debug host to force a target system reset. Writing 1 to this bit forces an MCU reset. This bit cannot be written from a user program. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 173 Development Support MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 174 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics A.1 Introduction This chapter contains electrical and timing specifications. A.2 Absolute Maximum Ratings Absolute maximum ratings are stress ratings only, and functional operation at the maxima is not guaranteed. Stress beyond the limits specified in Table A-1 may affect device reliability or cause permanent damage to the device. For functional operating conditions, refer to the remaining tables in this section. This device contains circuitry protecting against damage due to high static voltage or electrical fields; however, it is advised that normal precautions be taken to avoid application of any voltages higher than maximum-rated voltages to this high-impedance circuit. Reliability of operation is enhanced if unused inputs are tied to an appropriate logic voltage level (for instance, either VSS or VDD) or the programmable pull-up resistor associated with the pin is enabled. Table A-1. Absolute Maximum Ratings Rating Symbol Value Unit Supply voltage VDD –0.3 to +5.8 V Maximum current into VDD IDD 120 mA Digital input voltage VIn –0.3 to VDD + 0.3 V Instantaneous maximum current Single pin limit (applies to all port pins)1, 2, 3 ID ± 25 mA Tstg –55 to 150 °C Storage temperature range 1 Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required current-limiting resistor, calculate resistance values for positive (VDD) and negative (VSS) clamp voltages, then use the larger of the two resistance values. 2 All functional non-supply pins are internally clamped to V SS and VDD. 3 Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDD range during instantaneous and operating maximum current conditions. If positive injection current (VIn > VDD) is greater than IDD, the injection current may flow out of VDD and could result in external power supply going out of regulation. Ensure external VDD load will shunt current greater than maximum injection current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU is not consuming power. Examples are: if no system clock is present, or if the clock rate is very low (which would reduce overall power consumption). MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 175 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics A.3 Thermal Characteristics This section provides information about operating temperature range, power dissipation, and package thermal resistance. Power dissipation on I/O pins is usually small compared to the power dissipation in on-chip logic and voltage regulator circuits and it is user-determined rather than being controlled by the MCU design. In order to take PI/O into account in power calculations, determine the difference between actual pin voltage and VSS or VDD and multiply by the pin current for each I/O pin. Except in cases of unusually high pin current (heavy loads), the difference between pin voltage and VSS or VDD will be very small. Table A-2. Thermal Characteristics Rating Symbol Value Unit TA TL to TH –40 to 125 °C Thermal resistance (single-layer board) 8-pin PDIP 8-pin NB SOIC θJA 113 150 °C/W Thermal resistance (four-layer board) 8-pin PDIP 8-pin NB SOIC θJA 72 87 °C/W Operating temperature range (packaged) The average chip-junction temperature (TJ) in °C can be obtained from: TJ = TA + (PD × θJA) Eqn. A-1 where: TA = Ambient temperature, °C θJA = Package thermal resistance, junction-to-ambient, °C/W PD = Pint + PI/O Pint = IDD × VDD, Watts — chip internal power PI/O = Power dissipation on input and output pins — user determined For most applications, PI/O << Pint and can be neglected. An approximate relationship between PD and TJ (if PI/O is neglected) is: PD = K ÷ (TJ + 273°C) Eqn. A-2 Solving Equation A-1 and Equation A-2 for K gives: K = PD × (TA + 273°C) + θJA × (PD)2 Eqn. A-3 where K is a constant pertaining to the particular part. K can be determined from equation 3 by measuring PD (at equilibrium) for a known TA. Using this value of K, the values of PD and TJ can be obtained by solving Equation A-1 and Equation A-2 iteratively for any value of TA. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 176 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics A.4 ESD Protection and Latch-Up Immunity Although damage from electrostatic discharge (ESD) is much less common on these devices than on early CMOS circuits, normal handling precautions must be used to avoid exposure to static discharge. Qualification tests are performed to ensure that these devices can withstand exposure to reasonable levels of static without suffering any permanent damage. All ESD testing is in conformity with AEC-Q100 Stress Test Qualification for Automotive Grade Integrated Circuits. During the device qualification ESD stresses were performed for the human body model (HBM), the machine model (MM) and the charge device model (CDM). A device is defined as a failure if after exposure to ESD pulses the device no longer meets the device specification. Complete DC parametric and functional testing is performed per the applicable device specification at room temperature followed by hot temperature, unless specified otherwise in the device specification. Table A-3. ESD and Latch-up Test Conditions Model Human Body Machine Latch-up Description Symbol Value Unit Series resistance R1 1500 Ω Storage capacitance C 100 pF Number of pulses per pin — 3 Series resistance R1 0 Ω Storage capacitance C 200 pF Number of pulses per pin — 3 Minimum input voltage limit – 2.5 V Maximum input voltage limit 7.5 V Table A-4. ESD and Latch-Up Protection Characteristics No. 1 A.5 Rating1 Symbol Min Max Unit 1 Human body model (HBM) VHBM ± 2000 — V 2 Machine model (MM) VMM ± 200 — V 3 Charge device model (CDM) VCDM ± 500 — V 4 Latch-up current at TA = 85°C ILAT ± 100 — mA Parameter is achieved by design characterization on a small sample size from typical devices under typical conditions unless otherwise noted. DC Characteristics This section includes information about power supply requirements and I/O pin characteristics. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 177 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics Table A-5. DC Characteristics (Temperature Range = –40 to 125°C Ambient) Parameter Supply voltage (run, wait, and stop modes.) Symbol Min VDD 2.7 Minimum RAM retention supply voltage applied to VDD VRAM Low-voltage detection threshold — high range (Consumer and Industrial MC9S08QDx) VLVDH VDD falling VDD rising) VPOR Typical 1, 2 4.2 4.3 4.3 4.4 Max Unit 5.5 V — V 4.4 4.5 Low-voltage detection threshold — high range (Automotive S9S08QDx) V V V (VDD falling) –40°C to 0°C 0 to 125°C (VDD rising) –40°C to 0°C 0 to 125°C 4.175 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.4 4.5 4.275 4.3 4.3 4.4 4.4 4.5 2.48 2.54 2.56 2.62 2.64 2.7 4.2 4.3 4.3 4.4 4.4 4.5 Low-voltage detection threshold — low range (VDD falling) (VDD rising) Low-voltage warning threshold — high range (Consumer and Industrial MC9S08QDx) VLVDL VLVWH (VDD falling) (VDD rising) Low-voltage warning threshold — high range (Automotive S9S08QDx) V V V V V (VDD falling) –40°C to 0°C 0 to 125°C (VDD rising) –40°C to 0°C 0 to 125°C 4.175 4.2 4.3 4.4 4.4 4.5 4.275 4.3 4.3 4.4 4.4 4.5 VLVWL 2.48 2.54 2.56 2.62 2.64 2.7 V V Vhys — — 100 60 — — mV mV VBG 1.19 1.20 1.21 V 1.18 1.20 1.215 V Low-voltage warning threshold — low range (VDD falling) (VDD rising) Low-voltage inhibit reset/recover hysteresis 5V 3V Bandgap Voltage Reference (Consumer and Industrial MC9S08QDx) Factory trimmed at VDD = 3.0V, Temp = 25°C Bandgap Voltage Reference (S9S08QDx) Factory trimmed at VDD = 3.0V, Temp = 25°C –40°C to 125°C Input high voltage (2.7 V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5 V) (all digital inputs) VIH 0.7 × VDD — V Input low voltage (2.7 V ≤ VDD ≤ 5.5 V) (all digital inputs) VIL — 0.3 × VDD V Input hysteresis (all digital inputs) Vhys 0.06 × VDD — V Input leakage current (Per pin) VIn = VDD or VSS, all input only pins |IIn| — 1.0 μA 0.025 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 178 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics Table A-5. DC Characteristics (continued)(Temperature Range = –40 to 125°C Ambient) Parameter Symbol Min Typical Max Unit High impedance (off-state) leakage current (per pin) VIn = VDD or VSS, all input/output |IOZ| — 0.025 1.0 μA Internal pullup resistors3 RPU 17.5 52.5 κW Internal pulldown resistor (IRQ) RPD 17.5 52.5 κW VOH VDD – 1.5 VDD – 1.5 VDD – 0.8 VDD – 0.8 — — — — — — — — VDD – 1.5 VDD – 1.5 VDD – 0.8 VDD – 0.8 — — — — — — — — — — — — 100 60 — — — — — — — — 1.5 1.5 0.8 0.8 — — — — — — — — 1.5 1.5 0.8 0.8 — — — — 100 60 mA — — 0.2 5 mA mA — 7 pF Output high voltage — Low Drive (PTxDSn = 0) 5 V, ILoad = –2 mA 3 V, ILoad = –0.6 mA 5 V, ILoad = –0.4 mA 3 V, ILoad = –0.24 mA V Output high voltage — High Drive (PTxDSn = 1) 5 V, ILoad = –10 mA 3 V, ILoad = –3 mA 5 V, ILoad = –2 mA 3 V, ILoad = –0.4 mA Maximum total IOH for all port pins 5V 3V |IOHT| Output low voltage — Low Drive (PTxDSn = 0) 5 V, ILoad = 2 mA 3 V, ILoad = 0.6 mA 5 V, ILoad = 0.4 mA 3 V, ILoad = 0.24 mA VOL Output low voltage — High Drive (PTxDSn = 1) 5 V, ILoad = 10 mA 3 V, ILoad = 3 mA 5 V, ILoad = 2 mA 3 V, ILoad = 0.4 mA Maximum total IOL for all port pins 5V 3V 1 2 3 4 5 6 IOLT dc injection current(2), 4, 5, 6 VIN < VSS, VIN > VDD Single pin limit Total MCU limit, includes sum of all stressed pins |IIC| Input capacitance (all non-supply pins) CIn mA V RAM will retain data down to POR voltage. RAM data not guaranteed to be valid following a POR. This parameter is characterized and not tested on each device. Measurement condition for pull resistors: VIn = VSS for pullup and VIn = VDD for pulldown. All functional non-supply pins are internally clamped to VSS and VDD. Input must be current limited to the value specified. To determine the value of the required current-limiting resistor, calculate resistance values for positive and negative clamp voltages, then use the larger of the two values. Power supply must maintain regulation within operating VDD range during instantaneous and operating maximum current conditions. If positive injection current (VIn > VDD) is greater than IDD, the injection current may flow out of VDD and could result in external power supply going out of regulation. Ensure external VDD load will shunt current greater than maximum injection current. This will be the greatest risk when the MCU is not consuming power. Examples are: if no system clock is present, or if clock rate is very low (which would reduce overall power consumption). MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 179 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics Typical Low-side Driver (LDS) Characteristics, VDD = 5.0 V, PORTA 14 125 12 105 85 IOL/mA 10 8 25 6 0 4 –40 2 0 0 0.8 0.4 1.2 2 1.6 2.4 2.8 VOL/V Figure A-1. Typical Low-Side Driver (Sink) Characteristics Low Drive (PTxDSn = 0), VDD = 5.0V, VOL vs. IOL Typical Low-side Driver (LDS) Characteristics, VDD = 3.0 V, PORTA 6 125 5 105 IOL/mA 4 85 25 3 0 2 –40 1 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 VOL/V 1 1.2 1.4 –1.6 Figure A-2. Typical Low-Side Driver (Sink) Characteristics Low Drive (PTxDSn = 0), VDD = 3.0 V, VOL vs. IOL MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 180 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics Typical Low-side Driver (HDS) Characteristics, VDD = 5.0 V, PORTA 40 35 125 105 85 25 0 –40 30 IOL/mA 25 20 15 10 5 0 0 0.4 0.8 1.2 1.6 VOL/V 2 2.4 2.8 Figure A-3. Typical Low-Side Driver (Sink) Characteristics High Drive (PTxDSn = 1), VDD = 5.0 V, VOL vs. IOL Typical Low-side Driver (HDS) Characteristics, VDD = 3.0 V, PORTA 14 125 12 105 85 8 25 6 0 4 –40 IOL/mA 10 2 0 0 0.2 0.4 0.6 0.8 VOL/V 1 1.2 1.4 1.6 Figure A-4. Typical Low-Side Driver (Sink) Characteristics High Drive (PTxDSn = 1), VDD = 3.0 V, VOL vs. IOL MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 181 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics Typical High-side Driver (LDS) Characteristics, VDD = 5.0 V, PORTA IOH/mA 0 –1 125 –2 105 –3 85 –4 25 –5 0 –6 –40 –7 –8 2.4 2.8 3.2 3.6 4 VOH/V 4.4 4.8 5.2 Figure A-5. Typical High-Side Driver (Source) Characteristics Low Drive (PTxDSn = 0), VDD = 5.0 V, VOH vs. IOH Typical High-side Driver (LDS) Characteristics, VDD = 3.0 V, PORTA 0 125 –0.5 105 IOH/mA –1 85 25 –1.5 0 –2 –40 –2.5 –3 1.6 1.8 2 2.2 2.4 VOH/V 2.6 2.8 3 Figure A-6. Typical High-Side Driver (Source) Characteristics Low Drive (PTxDSn = 0), VDD = 3.0 V, VOH vs. IOH MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 182 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics Typical High-side Driver (HDS) Characteristics, VDD = 5.0 V, PORTA 0 125 105 85 25 0 –40 –5 IOH/mA –10 –15 –20 –25 –30 2.4 2.8 3.2 4 3.6 VOH/V 4.4 4.8 5.2 Figure A-7. Typical High-Side Driver (Source) Characteristics High Drive (PTxDSn = 1), VDD = 5.0 V, VOH vs. IOH Typical High-side Driver (HDS) Characteristics, VDD = 3.0 V, PORTA 0 125 105 85 25 0 –40 –2 IOH/mA –4 –6 –8 –10 –12 1.6 1.8 2 2.2 2.4 VOH/V 2.6 2.8 3 Figure A-8. Typical High-Side Driver (Source) Characteristics High Drive (PTxDSn = 1), VDD = 3.0 V, VOH vs. IOH MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 183 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics A.6 Supply Current Characteristics This section includes information about power supply current in various operating modes Table A-6. Supply Current Characteristics Parameter Symbol Run supply current3 measured at (CPU clock = 2 MHz, fBus = 1 MHz) RIDD Run supply current5 measured at (CPU clock = 16 MHz, fBus = 8 MHz) RIDD Wait mode supply current7 measured at (CPU clock = 16 MHz, fBus = 8 MHz) WIDD Stop2 mode supply current (Consumer and Industrial MC9S08QDx) –40 to 85°C –40 to 125°C –40 to 85°C –40 to 125°C –40 to 85°C –40 to 125°C –40 to 85°C –40 to 125°C Stop3 mode supply current (Consumer and Industrial MC9S08QDx) –40 to 85° C –40 to 125°C –40 to 85° C –40 to 125°C 5 0.95 1.54 3 0.90 1.5 5 3.5 56 3 3.4 5 5 1.55 2.2 3 1.50 2.2 5 0.80 7.58 20 4 3 0.80 7.08 15 5 0.80 7.59 25 4 3 0.80 7.08 20 5 0.90 8.08 254 3 0.90 7.18 20 5 0.90 8.08 304 3 0.90 7.18 25 5 400 nA 3 350 nA 5 110 μA S3IDD s Stop3 mode supply current (Automotive S9S08QDx) –40 to 85° C –40 to 125°C –40 to 85° C –40 to 125°C RTI adder to stop2 or stop310, 25°C LVD adder to stop3 (LVDE = LVDSE = 1) Adder to stop3 for oscillator enabled (IREFSTEN = 1) 2 Max2 S2IDD Stop2 mode supply current (Automotive S9S08QDx) 1 Typical1 VDD (V) Unit mA mA mA μA μA μA μA μA μA μA μA 3 90 μA 5 75 μA 3 65 μA Typicals are measured at 25°C. Values given here are preliminary estimates prior to completing characterization. MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 184 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics 3 All modules except ADC active, and does not include any dc loads on port pins Every unit tested to this parameter. All other values in the Max column are guaranteed by characterization. 5 All modules except ADC active, and does not include any dc loads on port pins 6 Every unit tested to this parameter. All other values in the Max column are guaranteed by characterization. 7 Most customers are expected to find that the auto-wakeup from a stop mode can be used instead of the higher current wait mode. 8 This parameter is characterized and not tested on each device. 9 This parameter is characterized and not tested on each device. 10 Most customers are expected to find that auto-wakeup from stop2 or stop3 can be used instead of the higher current wait mode. Wait mode typical is 560 μA at 3 V with fBus = 1 MHz. 4 Typical RIDD (VDD=5.0 V, ADC off) vs. Bus Freq. 4.00 3.50 125 105 85 25 0 –40 RIDD/mA 3.00 2.50 2.00 1.50 1.00 0.50 0.00 0 2 4 6 8 10 Bus/MHz Figure A-9. Typical Run IDD vs. Bus Freq. (FEI) (ADC off) MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 185 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics A.7 Internal Clock Source Characteristics Table A-7. Internal Clock Source Specifications Symbol Min Typ1 Max Unit Average internal reference frequency - untrimmed fint_ut 25 31.25 41.66 kHz Average internal reference frequency - trimmed fint_t — 31.25 — kHz DCO output frequency range - untrimmed fdco_ut 12.8 16 21.33 MHz DCO output frequency range - trimmed fdco_t — 16 — MHz — — ± 0.2 Characteristic Resolution of trimmed DCO output frequency at fixed voltage and temperature (Consumer and Industrial MC9S08QDx)2 Resolution of trimmed DCO output frequency at fixed voltage and temperature (Automotive S9S08QDx)2 –40°C to 0°C 0 to 125°C Δfdco_res_t Total deviation of trimmed DCO output frequency over voltage and temperature 2 Consumer and Industrial MC9S08QDx Automotive S9S08QDx Δfdco_t FLL acquisition time 2,3 tacquire Long term Jitter of DCO output clock (averaged over 2 ms interval) 4 CJitter %fdco — — — — — — ± 0.3 ± 0.2 ±2 ±3 %fdco 1 ms 0.6 %fdco 1 Data in Typical column was characterized at 3.0 V and 3.0 V, 25°C or is typical recommended value. Characterized, but not tested. 3 This specification applies to any time the FLL reference source or reference divider is changed, trim value changed or changing from FLL disabled (FBELP, FBILP) to FLL enabled (FEI, FEE, FBE, FBI). If a crystal/resonator is being used as the reference, this specification assumes it is already running. 4 Jitter is the average deviation from the programmed frequency measured over the specified interval at maximum f BUS. Measurements are made with the device powered by filtered supplies and clocked by a stable external clock signal. Noise injected into the FLL circuitry via VDD and VSS and variation in crystal oscillator frequency increase the CJitter percentage for a given interval. 2 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 186 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics Deviation of DCO Output from Trimmed Frequency (8 MHz, 5.5 V) 0.80% 0.70% 0.60% 0.50% Deviation 0.40% 0.30% 0.20% 0.10% 0.00% –0.10% –0.20% –0.30% –0.40% –40 –20 0 20 40 60 Temp. /C 80 100 120 140 Figure A-10. Typical Deviation of DCO Output vs. Temperature Deviation of DCO Output from Trimmed Frequency (8 MHz, 25 °C) 0.20% 0.15% Deviation 0.10% 0.05% 0.00% –0.05% –0.10% –0.15% –0.20% 2.5 3 3.5 4 4.5 5 5.5 6 VDD / V Figure A-11. Typical Deviation of DCO Output vs. Operating Voltage MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 187 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics A.8 AC Characteristics This section describes AC timing characteristics for each peripheral system. A.8.1 Control Timing Table A-8. Control Timing Symbol Min Typical1 Max Unit Bus frequency (tcyc = 1/fBus) fBus 1 — 8 MHz Real-time interrupt internal oscillator period tRTI 700 — 1300 μs textrst 100 — — ns IRQ pulse width Asynchronous path2 Synchronous path3 tILIH, tIHIL 100 1.5 tcyc — — KBIPx pulse width Asynchronous path2 Synchronous path3 tILIH, tIHIL 100 1.5 tcyc — — ns — — 3 30 — — ns Parameter External reset pulse width2 Port rise and fall time (load = 50 pF)4 Slew rate control disabled (PTxSE = 0) Slew rate control enabled (PTxSE = 1) ns tRise, tFall BKGD/MS setup time after issuing background debug force reset to enter user or BDM modes tMSSU 500 — — ns BKGD/MS hold time after issuing background debug force reset to enter user or BDM modes 5 tMSH 100 — — μs 1 Data in Typical column was characterized at 3.0 V, 25°C. This is the shortest pulse that is guaranteed to be recognized. 3 This is the minimum pulse width that is guaranteed to pass through the pin synchronization circuitry. Shorter pulses may or may not be recognized. In stop mode, the synchronizer is bypassed so shorter pulses can be recognized in that case. 4 Timing is shown with respect to 20% V DD and 80% VDD levels. Temperature range –40°C to 125°C. 5 To enter BDM mode following a POR, BKGD/MS must be held low during the power-up and for a hold time of tMSH after VDD rises above VLVD. 2 textrst RESET PIN Figure A-12. Reset Timing MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 188 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics tIHIL IRQ/KBIPx IRQ/KBIPx tILIH Figure A-13. IRQ/KBIPx Timing A.8.2 Timer/PWM (TPM) Module Timing Synchronizer circuits determine the shortest input pulses that can be recognized or the fastest clock that can be used as the optional external source to the timer counter. These synchronizers operate from the current bus rate clock. Table A-9. TPM/MTIM Input Timing Function Symbol Min Max Unit External clock frequency fTCLK dc fBus/4 MHz External clock period tTCLK 4 — tcyc External clock high time tclkh 1.5 — tcyc External clock low time tclkl 1.5 — tcyc tICPW 1.5 — tcyc Input capture pulse width tText tclkh TCLK tclkl Figure A-14. Timer External Clock tICPW TPMCHn TPMCHn tICPW Figure A-15. Timer Input Capture Pulse MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 189 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics A.9 ADC Characteristics Table A-10. ADC Characteristics Characteristic Supply Current ADLPC = 1 ADLSMP = 1 ADCO = 1 Conditions Symb VDDAD < 3.6 V (3.0 V Typ) VDDAD < 5.5 V (5.0 V Typ) Supply Current ADLPC = 1 ADLSMP = 0 ADCO = 1 VDDAD < 3.6 V (3.0 V Typ) Supply Current ADLPC = 0 ADLSMP = 1 ADCO = 1 VDDAD < 3.6 V (3.0 V Typ) Supply Current ADLPC = 0 ADLSMP = 0 ADCO = 1 VDDAD < 3.6V (3.0 V Typ) Supply Current Stop, Reset, Module Off VDDAD < 5.5 V (5.0 V Typ) VDDAD < 5.5 V (5.0 V Typ) VDDAD < 5.5V (5.0 V Typ) IDDAD IDDAD IDDAD IDDAD IDDAD Min Typ1 Max — 110 — — 130 — — 200 — — 220 — — 320 — — 360 — — 580 — — 660 — — <1 100 nA Unit μA μA μA Ref Voltage High VREFH 2.7 VDDAD VDDAD V VREFL VSSAD VSSAD VSSAD V 0.4 — 8.0 0.4 — 4.0 High Speed (ADLPC = 0) ADC Asynchronous Clock Source High Speed (ADLPC = 0) Conversion Time Short Sample (ADLSMP = 0) Low Power (ADLPC = 1) Low Power (ADLPC = 1) Long Sample (ADLSMP = 1) Sample Time Short Sample (ADLSMP = 0) Long Sample (ADLSMP = 1) fADCK fADACK tADC tADS Over temperature (Typ 25°C) μA Ref Voltage Low ADC Conversion Clock Comment MHz tADCK = 1/fADCK MHz tADACK = 1/fADACK 2.5 4 6.6 1.25 2 3.3 20 20 23 40 40 43 4 4 4 24 24 24 tADCK cycles V tADCK cycles Add 2 to 5 tBus =1/fBus cycles Input Voltage VADIN VREFL — VREFH Input Capacitance CADIN — 7 10 pF Not Tested Input Impedance RADIN — 5 15 kΩ Not Tested RAS — — 10(2) kΩ External to MCU 2.637 4.883 5.371 10.547 19.53 21.48 0 ±1.5 ±3.5 0 ±0.7 ±1.0 0 ±0.5 ±1.0 0 ±0.3 ±0.5 0 ±0.5 ±1.0 0 ±0.3 ±0.5 Analog Source Impedance Ideal Resolution (1LSB) 10 bit mode 8 bit mode Total Unadjusted Error 10 bit mode Differential Non-Linearity 10 bit mode 8 bit mode 8 bit mode RES ETUE DNL mV LSB VREFH/2N Includes quantization LSB Monotonicity and no-missing-codes guaranteed Integral Non-Linearity 10 bit mode 8 bit mode INL LSB MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 190 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix A Electrical Characteristics Table A-10. ADC Characteristics (continued) Characteristic Zero-Scale Error Full-Scale Error Quantization Error Conditions 10 bit mode Symb EZS 8 bit mode 10 bit mode EFS 8 bit mode 10 bit mode EQ Min Typ1 Max 0 ±1.5 ±3.1 0 ±0.5 ±0.7 0 ±1.0 ±1.5 0 ±0.5 ±0.5 — — ±0.5 Unit Comment LSB VADIN = VSSA LSB VADIN = VDDA LSB 8 bit mode is not truncated 1 Typical values assume VDDAD = 5.0 V, Temp = 25°C, fADCK=1.0 MHz unless otherwise stated. Typical values are for reference only and are not tested in production. 2 At 4 MHz, for maximum frequency, use proportionally lower source impedance. A.10 Flash Specifications This section provides details about program/erase times and program-erase endurance for the flash memory. Program and erase operations do not require any special power sources other than the normal VDD supply. For more detailed information about program/erase operations, see the Memory section. Table A-11. Flash Characteristics Characteristic Symbol Min Supply voltage for program/erase –40°C to 125°C Vprog/erase 2.7 Supply voltage for read operation VRead 2.7 5.5 V Internal FCLK frequency1 fFCLK 150 200 kHz tFcyc 5 6.67 μs Internal FCLK period (1/FCLK) Byte program time (random location)(2) Typical Max Unit 5.5 V tprog 9 tFcyc Byte program time (burst mode)(2) tBurst 4 tFcyc Page erase time2 tPage 4000 tFcyc Mass erase time(2) tMass 20,000 tFcyc Program/erase endurance3 TL to TH = –40°C to + 125°C T = 25°C Data retention4 tD_ret 10,000 — 100,000 — — cycles 15 100 — years 1 The frequency of this clock is controlled by a software setting. These values are hardware state machine controlled. User code does not need to count cycles. This information supplied for calculating approximate time to program and erase. 3 Typical endurance for flash was evaluated for this product family on the 9S12Dx64. For additional information on how Freescale defines typical endurance, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB619/D, Typical Endurance for Nonvolatile Memory. 4 Typical data retention values are based on intrinsic capability of the technology measured at high temperature and de-rated to 25°C using the Arrhenius equation. For additional information on how Freescale defines typical data retention, please refer to Engineering Bulletin EB618/D, Typical Data Retention for Nonvolatile Memory. 2 MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 191 Appendix A Electrical Characteristics MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 192 Freescale Semiconductor Appendix B Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings B.1 Ordering Information This section contains ordering numbers for the devices. Table B-1. Device Numbering System Memory Device Number1 1 B.1.1 • Available Packages Qualification Flash RAM Type Type MC9S08QD4 MC9S08QD2 4 KB 2 KB 256 B 128 B 8 PDIP 8 NB SOIC Consumer and Industrial S9S08QD4 S9S08QD2 4 KB 2 KB 256 B 128 B 8 NB SOIC Automotive See Table 1-2 for a complete description of modules included on each device. Device Numbering Scheme Numbering Scheme for Consumer and Industrial Products MC 9 S08 QD 4 X XX Status (MC = Fully Qualified) Memory (9 = Flash-based) Core Package designator (see Table B-2) Temperature range (M = –40°C to +125°C) (V = –40°C to +105°C) (C = –40°C to +85°C) Family Approximate memory size (in Kbytes) Figure 12-7. Numbering Scheme for Consumer and Industrial Products • Numbering Scheme for Automotive Products S 9 S08 QD 4 XX X XX Status (S = Fully Qualified) Memory (9 = Flash-based) Core Family Package designator (see Table B-2) Temperature range (M = –40°C to +125°C) (V = –40°C to +105°C) (C = –40°C to +85°C) Fab and Maskset Indicator Suffix Approximate memory size (in Kbytes) Figure B-1. Numbering Scheme for Automotive Products MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 Freescale Semiconductor 193 Appendix B Ordering Information and Mechanical Drawings B.2 Mechanical Drawings The following pages are mechanical specifications for the package options. See Table B-2 for the document number of each package type. Table B-2. Package Information Pin Count Type Designator Document No. 8 PDIP PC 98ASB42420B 8 NB SOIC SC 98ASB42564B MC9S08QD4 Series MCU Data Sheet, Rev. 3 194 Freescale Semiconductor How to Reach Us: Home Page: www.freescale.com E-mail: [email protected] USA/Europe or Locations Not Listed: Freescale Semiconductor Technical Information Center, CH370 1300 N. Alma School Road Chandler, Arizona 85224 +1-800-521-6274 or +1-480-768-2130 [email protected] Europe, Middle East, and Africa: Freescale Halbleiter Deutschland GmbH Technical Information Center Schatzbogen 7 81829 Muenchen, Germany +44 1296 380 456 (English) +46 8 52200080 (English) +49 89 92103 559 (German) +33 1 69 35 48 48 (French) [email protected] Japan: Freescale Semiconductor Japan Ltd. Headquarters ARCO Tower 15F 1-8-1, Shimo-Meguro, Meguro-ku, Tokyo 153-0064 Japan 0120 191014 or +81 3 5437 9125 [email protected] Asia/Pacific: Freescale Semiconductor Hong Kong Ltd. Technical Information Center 2 Dai King Street Tai Po Industrial Estate Tai Po, N.T., Hong Kong +800 2666 8080 [email protected] For Literature Requests Only: Freescale Semiconductor Literature Distribution Center P.O. Box 5405 Denver, Colorado 80217 1-800-441-2447 or 303-675-2140 Fax: 303-675-2150 [email protected] MC9S08QD4 Rev. 3, 11/2007 Information in this document is provided solely to enable system and software implementers to use Freescale Semiconductor products. There are no express or implied copyright licenses granted hereunder to design or fabricate any integrated circuits or integrated circuits based on the information in this document. Freescale Semiconductor reserves the right to make changes without further notice to any products herein. Freescale Semiconductor makes no warranty, representation or guarantee regarding the suitability of its products for any particular purpose, nor does Freescale Semiconductor assume any liability arising out of the application or use of any product or circuit, and specifically disclaims any and all liability, including without limitation consequential or incidental damages. “Typical” parameters that may be provided in Freescale Semiconductor data sheets and/or specifications can and do vary in different applications and actual performance may vary over time. All operating parameters, including “Typicals”, must be validated for each customer application by customer’s technical experts. Freescale Semiconductor does not convey any license under its patent rights nor the rights of others. Freescale Semiconductor products are not designed, intended, or authorized for use as components in systems intended for surgical implant into the body, or other applications intended to support or sustain life, or for any other application in which the failure of the Freescale Semiconductor product could create a situation where personal injury or death may occur. Should Buyer purchase or use Freescale Semiconductor products for any such unintended or unauthorized application, Buyer shall indemnify and hold Freescale Semiconductor and its officers, employees, subsidiaries, affiliates, and distributors harmless against all claims, costs, damages, and expenses, and reasonable attorney fees arising out of, directly or indirectly, any claim of personal injury or death associated with such unintended or unauthorized use, even if such claim alleges that Freescale Semiconductor was negligent regarding the design or manufacture of the part. RoHS-compliant and/or Pb-free versions of Freescale products have the functionality and electrical characteristics as their non-RoHS-compliant and/or non-Pb-free counterparts. For further information, see http://www.freescale.com or contact your Freescale sales representative. For information on Freescale’s Environmental Products program, go to http://www.freescale.com/epp. Freescale™ and the Freescale logo are trademarks of Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. All other product or service names are the property of their respective owners. © Freescale Semiconductor, Inc. 2006. All rights reserved.